blob: 5fa49d381632db09ea6c9b0e6748787ae15479e0 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau0e658fb2016-11-25 16:55:50 +01005 version 1.8
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02006 willy tarreau
Willy Tarreau7b677262017-04-03 09:27:49 +02007 2017/04/03
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02008
9
10This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
11specified above. It does not provide any hint, example or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013The summary below is meant to help you search sections by name and navigate
14through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040017 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
19 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
20 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020021 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
22 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outs) with 3
23 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to help get the difference between
24 inputs and outputs when it can become ambiguous. If you add sections,
25 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020026
27
28Summary
29-------
30
311. Quick reminder about HTTP
321.1. The HTTP transaction model
331.2. HTTP request
341.2.1. The Request line
351.2.2. The request headers
361.3. HTTP response
371.3.1. The Response line
381.3.2. The response headers
39
402. Configuring HAProxy
412.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200422.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200432.3. Environment variables
442.4. Time format
452.5. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020054
554. Proxies
564.1. Proxy keywords matrix
574.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
58
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200595. Bind and Server options
605.1. Bind options
615.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200625.3. Server DNS resolution
635.3.1. Global overview
645.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020065
666. HTTP header manipulation
67
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200687. Using ACLs and fetching samples
697.1. ACL basics
707.1.1. Matching booleans
717.1.2. Matching integers
727.1.3. Matching strings
737.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
747.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
757.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
767.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
777.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200787.3.1. Converters
797.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
807.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
817.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
827.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
837.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200847.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020085
868. Logging
878.1. Log levels
888.2. Log formats
898.2.1. Default log format
908.2.2. TCP log format
918.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +0100928.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +0100938.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200948.3. Advanced logging options
958.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
968.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
978.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
988.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
998.4. Timing events
1008.5. Session state at disconnection
1018.6. Non-printable characters
1028.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1038.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1048.9. Examples of logs
105
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001069. Supported filters
1079.1. Trace
1089.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001099.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200110
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200111
1121. Quick reminder about HTTP
113----------------------------
114
115When haproxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
116fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
117on almost anything found in the contents.
118
119However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
120formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
121correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
122
123
1241.1. The HTTP transaction model
125-------------------------------
126
127The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100128to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200129from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client on the
130connection, the server responds and the connection is closed. A new request
131will involve a new connection :
132
133 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
134
135In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
136establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
137by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
138length.
139
140Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
141to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
142however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
143response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
144header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
145
146 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
147
148Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
149power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
150but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200151a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200152
153A last improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
154keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
155second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
156page :
157
158 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
159
160This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
161latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
162correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
163the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100164server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200165
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100166By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
167connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
168leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
169start of a new request.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200170
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100171HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
172 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
173 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
174 everything else is forwarded with no analysis.
175 - passive close : tunnel with "Connection: close" added in both directions.
176 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
177 - forced close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
178
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200179
1801.2. HTTP request
181-----------------
182
183First, let's consider this HTTP request :
184
185 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100186 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200187 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
188 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
189 3 User-agent: my small browser
190 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
191 5 Accept: image/png
192
193
1941.2.1. The Request line
195-----------------------
196
197Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
198
199 - a METHOD : GET
200 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
201 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
202
203All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
204which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
205followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
206is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
207desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
208the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
209
210The URI itself can have several forms :
211
212 - A "relative URI" :
213
214 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
215
216 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
217 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
218
219 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
220
221 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
222
223 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
224 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
225 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
226 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
227 must accept this form too.
228
229 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
230 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
231 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100232
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200233 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
234 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
235 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
236 other protocols too.
237
238In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
239mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
240on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
241It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
242specific to the language, framework or application in use.
243
244
2451.2.2. The request headers
246--------------------------
247
248The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
249beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
250an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
251Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
252values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
253encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
254the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
255define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
256
257Contrary to a common mis-conception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
258their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
259"Connection:" header).
260
261The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
262that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
263is one valid form of empty line.
264
265Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
266headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
267about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
268application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
269
270Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000271 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200272 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
273 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
274 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
275
276
2771.3. HTTP response
278------------------
279
280An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
281messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
282
283 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100284 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200285 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
286 2 Content-length: 350
287 3 Content-Type: text/html
288
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200289As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
290codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
291response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100292continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
293the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
294following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
295sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
296(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
297correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
298such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
299state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
300over the same connection and that haproxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
301if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
302information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200303
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200304
3051.3.1. The Response line
306------------------------
307
308Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
309
310 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
311 - a status code : 200
312 - a reason : OK
313
314The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200315 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (eg: 100, 101)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200316 - 2xx = OK, content is following (eg: 200, 206)
317 - 3xx = OK, no content following (eg: 302, 304)
318 - 4xx = error caused by the client (eg: 401, 403, 404)
319 - 5xx = error caused by the server (eg: 500, 502, 503)
320
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000321Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100322"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200323found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
324messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
325or "Authentication Required".
326
327Haproxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
328
329 Code When / reason
330 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
331 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
332 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
333 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100334 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
335 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200336 400 for an invalid or too large request
337 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
338 accessing the stats page)
339 403 when a request is forbidden by a "block" ACL or "reqdeny" filter
340 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
341 500 when haproxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
342 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
343 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
344 when an "rspdeny" filter blocks the response.
345 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
346 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
347 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
348
349The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3504.2).
351
352
3531.3.2. The response headers
354---------------------------
355
356Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
357the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
358details.
359
360
3612. Configuring HAProxy
362----------------------
363
3642.1. Configuration file format
365------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200366
367HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
368
369 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
370 - the "global" section, which sets process-wide parameters
371 - the proxies sections which can take form of "defaults", "listen",
372 "frontend" and "backend".
373
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100374The configuration file syntax consists in lines beginning with a keyword
375referenced in this manual, optionally followed by one or several parameters
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200376delimited by spaces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100377
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200378
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02003792.2. Quoting and escaping
380-------------------------
381
382HAProxy's configuration introduces a quoting and escaping system similar to
383many programming languages. The configuration file supports 3 types: escaping
384with a backslash, weak quoting with double quotes, and strong quoting with
385single quotes.
386
387If spaces have to be entered in strings, then they must be escaped by preceding
388them by a backslash ('\') or by quoting them. Backslashes also have to be
389escaped by doubling or strong quoting them.
390
391Escaping is achieved by preceding a special character by a backslash ('\'):
392
393 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
394 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
395 \\ to use a backslash
396 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
397 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
398
399Weak quoting is achieved by using double quotes (""). Weak quoting prevents
400the interpretation of:
401
402 space as a parameter separator
403 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
404 # hash as a comment start
405
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200406Weak quoting permits the interpretation of variables, if you want to use a non
407-interpreted dollar within a double quoted string, you should escape it with a
408backslash ("\$"), it does not work outside weak quoting.
409
410Interpretation of escaping and special characters are not prevented by weak
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200411quoting.
412
413Strong quoting is achieved by using single quotes (''). Inside single quotes,
414nothing is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regexes.
415
416Quoted and escaped strings are replaced in memory by their interpreted
417equivalent, it allows you to perform concatenation.
418
419 Example:
420 # those are equivalents:
421 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
422 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
423 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
424 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
425 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
426
427 # those are equivalents:
428 reqrep "^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" \1\ /\2
429 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" '\1 /\2'
430 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1 /\2"
431 reqrep "^([^ :]*)\ /static/(.*)" "\1\ /\2"
432
433
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004342.3. Environment variables
435--------------------------
436
437HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
438interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
439configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
440optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
441shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
442underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit.
443
444 Example:
445
446 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
447
448 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
449
450 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
451
452
4532.4. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200454----------------
455
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100456Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100457values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
458otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
459numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
460for every keyword. Supported units are :
461
462 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
463 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
464 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
465 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
466 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
467 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
468
469
Lukas Tribusaa83a312017-03-21 09:25:09 +00004702.5. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200471-------------
472
473 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
474 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
475 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
476 global
477 daemon
478 maxconn 256
479
480 defaults
481 mode http
482 timeout connect 5000ms
483 timeout client 50000ms
484 timeout server 50000ms
485
486 frontend http-in
487 bind *:80
488 default_backend servers
489
490 backend servers
491 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
492
493
494 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
495 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
496 global
497 daemon
498 maxconn 256
499
500 defaults
501 mode http
502 timeout connect 5000ms
503 timeout client 50000ms
504 timeout server 50000ms
505
506 listen http-in
507 bind *:80
508 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
509
510
511Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
512
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100513 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200514
515
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005163. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200517--------------------
518
519Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
520are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
521of them have command-line equivalents.
522
523The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
524
525 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200526 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200527 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200528 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200529 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200530 - daemon
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200531 - description
532 - deviceatlas-json-file
533 - deviceatlas-log-level
534 - deviceatlas-separator
535 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900536 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200537 - gid
538 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100539 - hard-stop-after
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200540 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200541 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100542 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200543 - lua-load
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200544 - nbproc
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200545 - node
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200546 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100547 - presetenv
548 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200549 - uid
550 - ulimit-n
551 - user
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100552 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200553 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200554 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
555 - ssl-default-bind-options
556 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
557 - ssl-default-server-options
558 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100559 - ssl-server-verify
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100560 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100561 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100562 - 51degrees-data-file
563 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200564 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +0200565 - 51degrees-cache-size
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +0100566 - wurfl-data-file
567 - wurfl-information-list
568 - wurfl-information-list-separator
569 - wurfl-engine-mode
570 - wurfl-cache-size
571 - wurfl-useragent-priority
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100572
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200573 * Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +0200574 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200575 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +0200576 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +0100577 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +0100578 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100579 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +0200580 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +0200581 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +0200582 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200583 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200584 - noepoll
585 - nokqueue
586 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +0100587 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300588 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +0000589 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +0200590 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200591 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200592 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +0000593 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +0000594 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200595 - tune.buffers.limit
596 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200597 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +0200598 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +0100599 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +0100600 - tune.http.cookielen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +0200601 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +0100602 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100603 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +0100604 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100605 - tune.lua.session-timeout
606 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +0200607 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +0100608 - tune.maxaccept
609 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +0200610 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +0200611 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +0200612 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100613 - tune.rcvbuf.client
614 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +0100615 - tune.recv_enough
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +0100616 - tune.sndbuf.client
617 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +0100618 - tune.ssl.cachesize
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100619 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +0200620 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +0100621 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +0200622 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +0200623 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +0100624 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200625 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +0100626 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +0200627 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
628 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
629 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +0100630 - tune.zlib.memlevel
631 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100632
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200633 * Debugging
634 - debug
635 - quiet
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200636
637
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006383.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200639------------------------------------
640
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200641ca-base <dir>
642 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +0200643 relative path is used with "ca-file" or "crl-file" directives. Absolute
644 locations specified in "ca-file" and "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200645
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200646chroot <jail dir>
647 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
648 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
649 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
650 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
651 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
652 empty and unwritable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100653
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100654cpu-map <"all"|"odd"|"even"|process_num> <cpu-set>...
655 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process to a specific CPU
656 set. This means that the process will never run on other CPUs. The "cpu-map"
657 directive specifies CPU sets for process sets. The first argument is the
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100658 process number to bind. This process must have a number between 1 and 32 or
659 64, depending on the machine's word size, and any process IDs above nbproc
660 are ignored. It is possible to specify all processes at once using "all",
661 only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like with the
662 "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are CPU sets.
663 Each CPU set is either a unique number between 0 and 31 or 63 or a range with
664 two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Multiple CPU numbers or ranges
665 may be specified, and the processes will be allowed to bind to all of them.
666 Obviously, multiple "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map"
667 directive will replace the previous ones when they overlap.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +0100668
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200669crt-base <dir>
670 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
671 path is used with "crtfile" directives. Absolute locations specified after
672 "crtfile" prevail and ignore "crt-base".
673
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200674daemon
675 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
676 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
677 disabled by the command line "-db" argument.
678
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +0200679deviceatlas-json-file <path>
680 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
681 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by Haproxy process.
682
683deviceatlas-log-level <value>
684 Sets the level of informations returned by the API. This directive is
685 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
686
687deviceatlas-separator <char>
688 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
689 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
690
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +0100691deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200692 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
693 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
694 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +0100695
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900696external-check
697 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks.
698 This is disabled by default as a security precaution.
699 See "option external-check".
700
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200701gid <number>
702 Changes the process' group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
703 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
704 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +0100705 Note that if haproxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
706 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200707 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100708
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100709hard-stop-after <time>
710 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
711
712 Arguments :
713 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
714 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
715 SIGUSR1 signal.
716
717 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
718 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
719 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
720
721 Example:
722 global
723 hard-stop-after 30s
724
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200725group <group name>
726 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
727 See also "gid" and "user".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100728
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200729log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] <facility> [max level [min level]]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200730 Adds a global syslog server. Up to two global servers can be defined. They
731 will receive logs for startups and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100732 configured with "log global".
733
734 <address> can be one of:
735
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +0100736 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100737 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
738 port).
739
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +0100740 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
741 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
742 port).
743
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100744 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
745 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
746 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
747 writeable).
748
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200749 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
750 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +0100751
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +0200752 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
753 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
754 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
755 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
756 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
757 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
758 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
759 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
760 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
761 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
762 JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
763
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +0200764 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
765 one of the following :
766
767 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format. This is the default.
768 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
769
770 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
771 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
772
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +0100773 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200774
775 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
776 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
777 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
778
779 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +0200780 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
781 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
782 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
783 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
784 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
785 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200786
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200787 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200788
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100789log-send-hostname [<string>]
790 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
791 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
792 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
793 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
794 the logs.
795
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000796log-tag <string>
797 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
798 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
799 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +0100800 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +0000801
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +0100802lua-load <file>
803 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file. This directive can be
804 used multiple times.
805
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +0200806master-worker [exit-on-failure]
807 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
808 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
809 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
810 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
811 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
812 systemd.
813 The "exit-on-failure" option allows the master to kill every workers and
814 exit when one of the current workers died. It is convenient to combine this
815 option with Restart=on-failure in a systemd unit file in order to relaunch
816 the whole process.
817
818 See alors "-W" in the management guide.
819
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200820nbproc <number>
821 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
822 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
823 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
824 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
825 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. See also "daemon".
826
827pidfile <pidfile>
828 Writes pids of all daemons into file <pidfile>. This option is equivalent to
829 the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to the user
830 starting the process. See also "daemon".
831
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100832presetenv <name> <value>
833 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
834 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
835 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
836 and "unsetenv".
837
838resetenv [<name> ...]
839 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
840 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
841 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
842 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
843 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
844 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
845 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
846 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
847
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100848stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200849 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
850 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
851 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
852 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
853 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
854 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +0100855 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +0200856 word size (32 or 64). A better option consists in using the "process" setting
857 of the "stats socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +0200858
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200859server-state-base <directory>
860 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200861 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
862 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +0200863
864server-state-file <file>
865 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
866 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
867 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
868 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
869 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
870 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
871 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
872 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +0200873 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
874 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +0200875
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100876setenv <name> <value>
877 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
878 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
879 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
880 and "unsetenv".
881
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100882ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
883 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
884 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300885 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake for all "bind" lines which
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100886 do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
887 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string such
888 as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes). Please check the
889 "bind" keyword for more information.
890
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100891ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
892 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
893 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
894 keyword to see available options.
895
896 Example:
897 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +0200898 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100899
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100900ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
901 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
902 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +0300903 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server, for all "server"
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +0100904 lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is
905 defined in "man 1 ciphers". Please check the "server" keyword for more
906 information.
907
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +0100908ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
909 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
910 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
911 keyword to see available options.
912
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200913ssl-dh-param-file <file>
914 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
915 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
916 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
917 which do not explicitely define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
918 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200919 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
920 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
921 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
922 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +0200923 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
924 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
925 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
926
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +0100927ssl-server-verify [none|required]
928 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
929 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
930 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
931
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200932stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
933 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
934 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
935 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +0200936 consult section 9.2 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
937 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +0200938
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +0200939 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
940 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
941 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200942
943stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
944 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
945 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +0100946 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +0200947
948stats maxconn <connections>
949 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
950 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
951
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200952uid <number>
953 Changes the process' user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
954 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
955 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
956 one. See also "gid" and "user".
957
958ulimit-n <number>
959 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
960 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
961 option.
962
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +0100963unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
964 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
965
966 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
967 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
968 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
969 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
970 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
971 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before haproxy chroots
972 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
973 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
974 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
975 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
976
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +0100977unsetenv [<name> ...]
978 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
979 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
980 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
981 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
982 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
983 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
984 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
985
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200986user <user name>
987 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
988 See also "uid" and "group".
989
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +0200990node <name>
991 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
992
993 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
994 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
995 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
996 traffic.
997
998description <text>
999 Add a text that describes the instance.
1000
1001 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
1002 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
1003 "<" and ">" characters.
1004
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100100551degrees-data-file <file path>
1006 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
1007 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevavnt permissions.
1008
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001009 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001010 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1011
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000101251degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001013 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
1014 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
1015 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
1016
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001017 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001018 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1019
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200102051degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001021 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
1022 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
1023
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001024 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
1025 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1026
102751degrees-cache-size <number>
1028 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
1029 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
1030 By default, this cache is disabled.
1031
1032 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001033 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
1034
scientiamobiled0027ed2016-11-04 10:55:08 +01001035wurfl-data-file <file path>
1036 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
1037 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
1038
1039 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1040 with USE_WURFL=1.
1041
1042wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
1043 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
1044 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
1045 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
1046
1047 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
1048
1049 Valid WURFL properties are:
1050 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
1051
1052 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
1053 device.
1054
1055 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
1056 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
1057
1058 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
1059 particular web request.
1060
1061 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
1062 used Libwurfl API version.
1063
1064 - wurfl_engine_target Contains a string representing the currently
1065 set WURFL Engine Target. Possible values are
1066 "HIGH_ACCURACY", "HIGH_PERFORMANCE", "INVALID".
1067
1068 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
1069 wurfl.xml and its full path.
1070
1071 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
1072 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
1073
1074 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
1075
1076 - wurfl_useragent_priority The user agent priority used by WURFL.
1077
1078 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1079 with USE_WURFL=1.
1080
1081wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
1082 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
1083 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
1084
1085 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1086 with USE_WURFL=1.
1087
1088wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
1089 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
1090 thus before the chroot.
1091
1092 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1093 with USE_WURFL=1.
1094
1095wurfl-engine-mode { accuracy | performance }
1096 Sets the WURFL engine target. You can choose between 'accuracy' or
1097 'performance' targets. In performance mode, desktop web browser detection is
1098 done programmatically without referencing the WURFL data. As a result, most
1099 desktop web browsers are returned as generic_web_browser WURFL ID for
1100 performance. If either performance or accuracy are not defined, performance
1101 mode is enabled by default.
1102
1103 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1104 with USE_WURFL=1.
1105
1106wurfl-cache-size <U>[,<D>]
1107 Sets the WURFL caching strategy. Here <U> is the Useragent cache size, and
1108 <D> is the internal device cache size. There are three possibilities here :
1109 - "0" : no cache is used.
1110 - <U> : the Single LRU cache is used, the size is expressed in elements.
1111 - <U>,<D> : the Double LRU cache is used, both sizes are in elements. This is
1112 the highest performing option.
1113
1114 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1115 with USE_WURFL=1.
1116
1117wurfl-useragent-priority { plain | sideloaded_browser }
1118 Tells WURFL if it should prioritize use of the plain user agent ('plain')
1119 over the default sideloaded browser user agent ('sideloaded_browser').
1120
1121 Please note that this option is only available when haproxy has been compiled
1122 with USE_WURFL=1.
1123
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001124
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011253.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001126-----------------------
1127
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001128max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
1129 By default, haproxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
1130 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
1131 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
1132 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
1133 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
1134 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
1135 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
1136 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
1137
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001138maxconn <number>
1139 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
1140 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
1141 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02001142 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
1143 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
1144 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
1145 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001146 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will default to the value
1147 set in DEFAULT_MAXCONN at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) if no memory
1148 limit is enforced, or will be computed based on the memory limit, the buffer
1149 size, memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use or not of SSL
1150 and the associated maxsslconn (which can also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001151
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001152maxconnrate <number>
1153 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
1154 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1155 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1156 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1157 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1158 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1159 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1160 fairness.
1161
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001162maxcomprate <number>
1163 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001164 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001165 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
1166 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
1167 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
1168 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
1169 default value.
1170
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001171maxcompcpuusage <number>
1172 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
1173 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
1174 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
1175 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by haproxy. In
1176 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
1177 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
1178 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
1179 process down and from introducing high latencies.
1180
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001181maxpipes <number>
1182 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
1183 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
1184 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
1185 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
1186 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
1187 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
1188
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001189maxsessrate <number>
1190 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
1191 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
1192 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
1193 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
1194 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
1195 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
1196 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
1197 fairness.
1198
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001199maxsslconn <number>
1200 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
1201 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
1202 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
1203 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
1204 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
1205 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
1206 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01001207 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
1208 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
1209 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
1210 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
1211 when there is a memory limit, haproxy will automatically adjust these values
1212 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
1213 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001214
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001215maxsslrate <number>
1216 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
1217 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
1218 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
1219 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
1220 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
1221 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
1222 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
1223 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
1224 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
1225 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
1226
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01001227maxzlibmem <number>
1228 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
1229 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
1230 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01001231 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
1232 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
1233 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
1234
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001235noepoll
1236 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
1237 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001238 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001239
1240nokqueue
1241 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
1242 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
1243 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
1244
1245nopoll
1246 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
1247 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001248 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01001249 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue" and "noepoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001250
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001251nosplice
1252 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
1253 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
1254 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001255 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001256 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
1257 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
1258 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
1259 "option splice-response".
1260
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001261nogetaddrinfo
1262 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
1263 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
1264
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001265noreuseport
1266 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
1267 command line argument "-dR".
1268
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001269spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09001270 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
1271 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
1272 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
1273 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
1274 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
1275 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001276
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001277ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-seperated list of algorithms>]
1278 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
1279 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
1280 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
1281 unsupported engine will prevent haproxy from starting. Note that many engines
1282 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
1283 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
1284 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
1285 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
1286 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-seperated list
1287 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
1288 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
1289 openssl configuration file uses:
1290 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
1291
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001292ssl-mode-async
1293 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02001294 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
1295 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines.
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001296
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01001297tune.buffers.limit <number>
1298 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
1299 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
1300 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
1301 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
1302 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
1303 behaviour. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
1304 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
1305 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
1306 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
1307 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
1308 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
1309 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
1310 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
1311 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
1312 advised to do so by an haproxy core developer.
1313
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01001314tune.buffers.reserve <number>
1315 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
1316 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
1317 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
1318 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at haproxy core developers.
1319
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001320tune.bufsize <number>
1321 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
1322 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
1323 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
1324 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
1325 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
1326 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
1327 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
1328 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased.
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04001329 If HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), haproxy will
1330 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
1331 than this size, haproxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway).
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001332
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001333tune.chksize <number>
1334 Sets the check buffer size to this size (in bytes). Higher values may help
1335 find string or regex patterns in very large pages, though doing so may imply
1336 more memory and CPU usage. The default value is 16384 and can be changed at
1337 build time. It is not recommended to change this value, but to use better
1338 checks whenever possible.
1339
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001340tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
1341 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
1342 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
1343 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
1344 this value. The default value is 1.
1345
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001346tune.http.cookielen <number>
1347 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
1348 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
1349 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
1350 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
1351 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
1352 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
1353 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
1354 to change this value.
1355
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001356tune.http.maxhdr <number>
1357 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
1358 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
1359 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
1360 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
1361 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
1362 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
1363 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. Keep in mind that each
1364 new header consumes 32bits of memory for each session, so don't push this
1365 limit too high.
1366
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001367tune.idletimer <timeout>
1368 Sets the duration after which haproxy will consider that an empty buffer is
1369 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
1370 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
1371 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
1372 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
1373 means that haproxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
1374 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (eg: read a page before
1375 clicking). There should be not reason for changing this value. Please check
1376 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
1377
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001378tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
1379 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01001380 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001381 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
1382 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
1383 executes some Lua code but more reactivity is required, this value can be
1384 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
1385 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
1386
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001387tune.lua.maxmem
1388 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
1389 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
1390 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
1391 memory.
1392
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001393tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
1394 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001395 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1396 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1397 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001398
1399tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
1400 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
1401 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
1402 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
1403 check servers.
1404
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001405tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
1406 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
1407 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
1408 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
1409 not taked in account. The default timeout is 4s.
1410
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001411tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01001412 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
1413 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
1414 give better performance at high connection rates. However in multi-process
1415 modes, keeping a bit of fairness between processes generally is better to
1416 increase performance. This value applies individually to each listener, so
1417 that the number of processes a listener is bound to is taken into account.
1418 This value defaults to 64. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice
1419 the number of processes the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1
1420 completely disables the limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak
1421 this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001422
1423tune.maxpollevents <number>
1424 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
1425 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
1426 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
1427 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
1428 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
1429
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001430tune.maxrewrite <number>
1431 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
1432 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
1433 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
1434 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
1435 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
1436 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
1437 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
1438 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
1439 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
1440 bufsize.
1441
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001442tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
1443 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
1444 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
1445 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
1446 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
1447 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
1448 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
1449 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
1450 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
1451 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
1452 about 5 MB on 32-bit systems and 8 MB on 64-bit systems. There is a very low
1453 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
1454 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
1455 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
1456 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
1457 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
1458 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
1459 setting this parameter to 0.
1460
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001461tune.pipesize <number>
1462 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
1463 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
1464 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
1465 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
1466 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
1467 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
1468
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001469tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
1470tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
1471 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
1472 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1473 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1474 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1475 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1476 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1477 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1478
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001479tune.recv_enough <number>
1480 Haproxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
1481 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
1482 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
1483 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
1484 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
1485
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001486tune.sndbuf.client <number>
1487tune.sndbuf.server <number>
1488 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
1489 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
1490 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
1491 the kernel autotune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
1492 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (eg: 4096) in
1493 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
1494 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
1495 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
1496 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
1497 notifying haproxy again.
1498
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001499tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001500 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
1501 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate.
1502 An encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001503 depending on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01001504 200 bytes of memory. The default value may be forced at build time, otherwise
1505 defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most idle entries are purged
1506 and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence of such a purge, hence
1507 the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring that all users keep
1508 their session as long as possible. All entries are pre-allocated upon startup
Emeric Brun22890a12012-12-28 14:41:32 +01001509 and are shared between all processes if "nbproc" is greater than 1. Setting
1510 this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001511
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001512tune.ssl.force-private-cache
1513 This boolean disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
1514 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
1515 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
1516 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
1517 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
1518 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
1519
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001520tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
1521 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001522 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01001523 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
1524 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
1525 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
1526 being used for too long.
1527
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001528tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
1529 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
1530 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
1531 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
1532 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
1533 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
1534 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
1535 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
1536 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
1537 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
1538 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001539 best value. Haproxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
1540 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001541
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001542tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
1543 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
1544 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
1545 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
1546 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
1547 this maximum value. Default value if 1024. Only 1024 or higher values are
1548 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
1549 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001550 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
1551 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001552
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001553tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
1554 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
1555 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
1556 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
1557 1000 entries.
1558
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001559tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
1560 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
1561 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
1562 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
1563
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001564tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001565tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001566tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
1567tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
1568tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001569 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
1570 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
1571 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
1572 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
1573 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
1574 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
1575 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
1576 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001577
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01001578 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
1579 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
1580 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
1581 all available space is consumed.
1582 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
1583 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
1584 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001585
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001586tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
1587 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001588 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001589 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
1590 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
1591 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
1592
1593tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
1594 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
1595 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
1596 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
1597 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001598
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015993.3. Debugging
1600--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001601
1602debug
1603 Enables debug mode which dumps to stdout all exchanges, and disables forking
1604 into background. It is the equivalent of the command-line argument "-d". It
1605 should never be used in a production configuration since it may prevent full
1606 system startup.
1607
1608quiet
1609 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
1610 line argument "-q".
1611
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001612
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010016133.4. Userlists
1614--------------
1615It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
1616http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
1617it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
1618
1619userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001620 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001621 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
1622
1623group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001624 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001625 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
1626 proceeded by "users" keyword.
1627
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001628user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
1629 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001630 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
1631 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01001632 evaluated using the crypt(3) function so depending of the system's
1633 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example modern Glibc
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001634 based Linux system supports MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512 and of course classic,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001635 DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001636
1637
1638 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001639 userlist L1
1640 group G1 users tiger,scott
1641 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001642
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001643 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
1644 user scott insecure-password elgato
1645 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001646
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001647 userlist L2
1648 group G1
1649 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001650
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01001651 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
1652 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
1653 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01001654
1655 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001656
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001657
16583.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001659----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02001660It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
1661several haproxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
1662instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
1663values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
1664automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
1665In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
1666using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
1667tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
1668reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
1669Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
1670that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
1671each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001672
1673peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001674 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001675 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
1676
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02001677disabled
1678 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
1679 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
1680 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
1681
1682enable
1683 This re-enables a disabled peers section which was previously disabled.
1684
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001685peer <peername> <ip>:<port>
1686 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
1687 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
1688 using "-L" command line option), haproxy will listen for incoming remote peer
1689 connection on <ip>:<port>. Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to
1690 to join the remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to
1691 identify and validate the remote peer on the server side.
1692
1693 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
1694 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
1695
1696 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
1697 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument to change the local
1698 peer name. This makes it easier to maintain coherent configuration files
1699 across all peers.
1700
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001701 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1702 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001703
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001704 Example:
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001705 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001706 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
1707 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
1708 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001709
1710 backend mybackend
1711 mode tcp
1712 balance roundrobin
1713 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
1714 stick on src
1715
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01001716 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1717 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02001718
1719
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090017203.6. Mailers
1721------------
1722It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
1723If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
1724in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
1725
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02001726mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001727 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
1728 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
1729
1730mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
1731 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
1732
1733 Example:
1734 mailers mymailers
1735 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
1736 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
1737
1738 backend mybackend
1739 mode tcp
1740 balance roundrobin
1741
1742 email-alert mailers mymailers
1743 email-alert from test1@horms.org
1744 email-alert to test2@horms.org
1745
1746 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
1747 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
1748
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01001749timeout mail <time>
1750 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
1751 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
1752 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
1753 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
1754
1755 Example:
1756 mailers mymailers
1757 timeout mail 20s
1758 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001759
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017604. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001761----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001762
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001763Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
William Lallemand6e62fb62015-04-28 16:55:23 +02001764 - defaults [<name>]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001765 - frontend <name>
1766 - backend <name>
1767 - listen <name>
1768
1769A "defaults" section sets default parameters for all other sections following
1770its declaration. Those default parameters are reset by the next "defaults"
1771section. See below for the list of parameters which can be set in a "defaults"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001772section. The name is optional but its use is encouraged for better readability.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001773
1774A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
1775connections.
1776
1777A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
1778to forward incoming connections.
1779
1780A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
1781parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
1782
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001783All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
1784'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
1785case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
1786
1787Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
1788logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
1789proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
1790However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
1791name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
1792
1793Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
1794and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01001795bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001796protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
1797modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
1798arbitrary criteria.
1799
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001800In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
1801a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
1802the backend's. HAProxy supports 5 connection modes :
1803
1804 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
1805 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
1806 between responses and new requests.
1807
1808 - TUN: tunnel ("option http-tunnel") : this was the default mode for versions
1809 1.0 to 1.5-dev21 : only the first request and response are processed, and
1810 everything else is forwarded with no analysis at all. This mode should not
1811 be used as it creates lots of trouble with logging and HTTP processing.
1812
1813 - PCL: passive close ("option httpclose") : exactly the same as tunnel mode,
1814 but with "Connection: close" appended in both directions to try to make
1815 both ends close after the first request/response exchange.
1816
1817 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
1818 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
1819 client-facing connection remains open.
1820
1821 - FCL: forced close ("option forceclose") : the connection is actively closed
1822 after the end of the response.
1823
1824The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
1825frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
1826following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
1827weakest option and force close is the strongest.
1828
1829 Backend mode
1830
1831 | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1832 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1833 KAL | KAL | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1834 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1835 TUN | TUN | TUN | PCL | SCL | FCL
1836 Frontend ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1837 mode PCL | PCL | PCL | PCL | FCL | FCL
1838 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1839 SCL | SCL | SCL | FCL | SCL | FCL
1840 ----+-----+-----+-----+-----+----
1841 FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL | FCL
1842
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001843
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01001844
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020018454.1. Proxy keywords matrix
1846--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001847
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001848The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
1849limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
1850they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
1851limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001852marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, eg. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001853option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02001854and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
1855with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
1856specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01001857
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001858
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001859 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
1860------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
1861acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02001862appsession - - - -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001863backlog X X X -
1864balance X - X X
1865bind - X X -
1866bind-process X X X X
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02001867block (deprecated) - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001868capture cookie - X X -
1869capture request header - X X -
1870capture response header - X X -
1871clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02001872compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001873contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
1874cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02001875declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001876default-server X - X X
1877default_backend X X X -
1878description - X X X
1879disabled X X X X
1880dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001881email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09001882email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09001883email-alert mailers X X X X
1884email-alert myhostname X X X X
1885email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001886enabled X X X X
1887errorfile X X X X
1888errorloc X X X X
1889errorloc302 X X X X
1890-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1891errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001892force-persist - X X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001893filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001894fullconn X - X X
1895grace X X X X
1896hash-type X - X X
1897http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01001898http-check expect - - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02001899http-check send-state X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001900http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02001901http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02001902http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02001903http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001904id - X X X
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02001905ignore-persist - X X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001906load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02001907log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01001908log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001909log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001910log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02001911max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001912maxconn X X X -
1913mode X X X X
1914monitor fail - X X -
1915monitor-net X X X -
1916monitor-uri X X X -
1917option abortonclose (*) X - X X
1918option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
1919option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
1920option allbackups (*) X - X X
1921option checkcache (*) X - X X
1922option clitcpka (*) X X X -
1923option contstats (*) X X X -
1924option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
1925option dontlognull (*) X X X -
1926option forceclose (*) X X X X
1927-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
1928option forwardfor X X X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02001929option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02001930option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01001931option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02001932option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02001933option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001934option http-server-close (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01001935option http-tunnel (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001936option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
1937option httpchk X - X X
1938option httpclose (*) X X X X
1939option httplog X X X X
1940option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04001941option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02001942option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001943option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001944option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
1945option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
1946option logasap (*) X X X -
1947option mysql-check X - X X
1948option nolinger (*) X X X X
1949option originalto X X X X
1950option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02001951option pgsql-check X - X X
1952option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001953option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02001954option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001955option smtpchk X - X X
1956option socket-stats (*) X X X -
1957option splice-auto (*) X X X X
1958option splice-request (*) X X X X
1959option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01001960option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001961option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
1962option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
1963-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01001964option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001965option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
1966option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
1967option tcpka X X X X
1968option tcplog X X X X
1969option transparent (*) X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001970external-check command X - X X
1971external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001972persist rdp-cookie X - X X
1973rate-limit sessions X X X -
1974redirect - X X X
1975redisp (deprecated) X - X X
1976redispatch (deprecated) X - X X
1977reqadd - X X X
1978reqallow - X X X
1979reqdel - X X X
1980reqdeny - X X X
1981reqiallow - X X X
1982reqidel - X X X
1983reqideny - X X X
1984reqipass - X X X
1985reqirep - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001986reqitarpit - X X X
1987reqpass - X X X
1988reqrep - X X X
1989-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01001990reqtarpit - X X X
1991retries X - X X
1992rspadd - X X X
1993rspdel - X X X
1994rspdeny - X X X
1995rspidel - X X X
1996rspideny - X X X
1997rspirep - X X X
1998rsprep - X X X
1999server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02002000server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02002001server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002002source X - X X
2003srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02002004stats admin - X X X
2005stats auth X X X X
2006stats enable X X X X
2007stats hide-version X X X X
2008stats http-request - X X X
2009stats realm X X X X
2010stats refresh X X X X
2011stats scope X X X X
2012stats show-desc X X X X
2013stats show-legends X X X X
2014stats show-node X X X X
2015stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002016-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
2017stick match - - X X
2018stick on - - X X
2019stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02002020stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01002021stick-table - X X X
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02002022tcp-check connect - - X X
2023tcp-check expect - - X X
2024tcp-check send - - X X
2025tcp-check send-binary - - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02002026tcp-request connection - X X -
2027tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02002028tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02002029tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02002030tcp-response content - - X X
2031tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002032timeout check X - X X
2033timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002034timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002035timeout clitimeout (deprecated) X X X -
2036timeout connect X - X X
2037timeout contimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2038timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
2039timeout http-request X X X X
2040timeout queue X - X X
2041timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02002042timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002043timeout srvtimeout (deprecated) X - X X
2044timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02002045timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002046transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01002047unique-id-format X X X -
2048unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002049use_backend - X X -
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02002050use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01002051------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
2052 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002053
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002054
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020554.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
2056---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002057
2058This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
2059
2060
2061acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
2062 Declare or complete an access list.
2063 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2064 no | yes | yes | yes
2065 Example:
2066 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2067 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2068 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
2069
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002070 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002071
2072
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002073appsession <cookie> len <length> timeout <holdtime>
2074 [request-learn] [prefix] [mode <path-parameters|query-string>]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002075 Define session stickiness on an existing application cookie.
2076 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2077 no | no | yes | yes
2078 Arguments :
2079 <cookie> this is the name of the cookie used by the application and which
2080 HAProxy will have to learn for each new session.
2081
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002082 <length> this is the max number of characters that will be memorized and
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002083 checked in each cookie value.
2084
2085 <holdtime> this is the time after which the cookie will be removed from
2086 memory if unused. If no unit is specified, this time is in
2087 milliseconds.
2088
Cyril Bontébf47aeb2009-10-15 00:15:40 +02002089 request-learn
2090 If this option is specified, then haproxy will be able to learn
2091 the cookie found in the request in case the server does not
2092 specify any in response. This is typically what happens with
2093 PHPSESSID cookies, or when haproxy's session expires before
2094 the application's session and the correct server is selected.
2095 It is recommended to specify this option to improve reliability.
2096
Cyril Bontéb21570a2009-11-29 20:04:48 +01002097 prefix When this option is specified, haproxy will match on the cookie
2098 prefix (or URL parameter prefix). The appsession value is the
2099 data following this prefix.
2100
2101 Example :
2102 appsession ASPSESSIONID len 64 timeout 3h prefix
2103
2104 This will match the cookie ASPSESSIONIDXXXX=XXXXX,
2105 the appsession value will be XXXX=XXXXX.
2106
2107 mode This option allows to change the URL parser mode.
2108 2 modes are currently supported :
2109 - path-parameters :
2110 The parser looks for the appsession in the path parameters
2111 part (each parameter is separated by a semi-colon), which is
2112 convenient for JSESSIONID for example.
2113 This is the default mode if the option is not set.
2114 - query-string :
2115 In this mode, the parser will look for the appsession in the
2116 query string.
2117
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002118 As of version 1.6, appsessions was removed. It is more flexible and more
2119 convenient to use stick-tables instead, and stick-tables support multi-master
2120 replication and data conservation across reloads, which appsessions did not.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002121
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01002122 See also : "cookie", "capture cookie", "balance", "stick", "stick-table",
2123 "ignore-persist", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002124
2125
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002126backlog <conns>
2127 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
2128 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2129 yes | yes | yes | no
2130 Arguments :
2131 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
2132 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002133 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01002134
2135 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
2136 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
2137 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
2138 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
2139 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
2140 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
2141 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
2142 backlog parameter.
2143
2144 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
2145 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
2146 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
2147
2148 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
2149
2150
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002151balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002152balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002153 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
2154 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2155 yes | no | yes | yes
2156 Arguments :
2157 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
2158 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
2159 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
2160 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
2161
2162 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2163 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
2164 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
2165 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002166 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08002167 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02002168 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
2169 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
2170 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
2171 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
2172 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
2173 it, so that you don't worry.
2174
2175 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
2176 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
2177 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
2178 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
2179 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
2180 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
2181 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
2182 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002183
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01002184 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
2185 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
2186 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
2187 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
2188 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
2189 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
2190 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
2191 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance.
2192
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002193 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002194 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002195 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
2196 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002197 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002198 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
2199 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
2200 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
2201 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
2202 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02002203 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
2204 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
2205 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
2206 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
2207 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
2208 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01002209
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002210 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
2211 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
2212 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
2213 address will always reach the same server as long as no
2214 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
2215 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
2216 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
2217 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002218 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002219 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002220 static by default, which means that changing a server's
2221 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
2222 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002223
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002224 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
2225 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
2226 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
2227 the running servers. The result designates which server will
2228 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
2229 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
2230 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
2231 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
2232 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
2233 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2234 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2235 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002236
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01002237 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002238 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
2239 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
2240 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
2241 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
2242 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
2243 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
2244 URIs start with a leading "/".
2245
2246 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
2247 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
2248 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
2249 evaluation stops when either is reached.
2250
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002251 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002252 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
2253
2254 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002255 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
2256 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002257 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
2258 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
2259 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
2260 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002261 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02002262 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
2263 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002264
2265 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
2266 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
2267 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
2268 server will receive the request.
2269
2270 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
2271 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
2272 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
2273 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
2274 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002275 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
2276 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
2277 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002278
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002279 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
2280 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
2281 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
2282 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
2283 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002284
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002285 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002286 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
2287 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
2288 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
2289
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002290 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2291 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2292 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2293
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002294 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02002295 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002296 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
2297 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
2298 with the equivalent ACL 'req_rdp_cookie()' function, the name
2299 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
2300 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
2301 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002302 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02002303 used instead.
2304
2305 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
2306 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
2307 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
2308 a 'req_rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
2309
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02002310 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
2311 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
2312 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
2313
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002314 See also the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09002315
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002316 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02002317 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
2318 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002319
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01002320 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
2321 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
2322 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002323
2324 Examples :
2325 balance roundrobin
2326 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002327 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01002328 balance hdr(User-Agent)
2329 balance hdr(host)
2330 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002331
2332 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
2333 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
2334
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002335 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002336 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
2337 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
2338 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
2339 the body. (see acl reqideny http_end)
2340
2341 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
2342 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
2343 defaults to 16 kB.
2344
2345 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
2346 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
2347
2348 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
2349 Round Robin.
2350
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00002351 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002352 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
2353 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
2354 actually appeared in the first chunk).
2355
2356 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
2357
2358 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002359 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02002360 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
2361 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
2362 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002363
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02002364 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002365
2366
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002367bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2368bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002369 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
2370 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2371 no | yes | yes | no
2372 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002373 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
2374 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
2375 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
2376 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01002377 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002378 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
2379 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
2380 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
2381 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
2382 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
2383 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
2384 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02002385 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
2386 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
2387 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
2388 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
2389 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
2390 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
2391 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01002392 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
2393 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
2394 be listening.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002395 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
2396 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
2397 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01002398
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002399 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
2400 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002401 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
2402 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
2403 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002404 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
2405 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
2406 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
2407 the range.
2408
2409 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
2410 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
2411 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
2412 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
2413 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
2414 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
2415 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002416 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01002417 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002418
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002419 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
2420 alternative to the TCP listening port. Haproxy will then
2421 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
2422 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
2423 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
2424 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
2425 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
2426 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
2427
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002428 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
2429 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
2430 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
2431 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002432
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002433 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
2434 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
2435 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
2436 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
2437 in a frontend.
2438
2439 Example :
2440 listen http_proxy
2441 bind :80,:443
2442 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002443 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002444
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002445 listen http_https_proxy
2446 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02002447 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02002448
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01002449 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
2450 bind ipv6@:80
2451 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
2452 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
2453
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002454 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02002455 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01002456
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02002457 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
2458 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
2459 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
2460 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
2461 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
2462
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002463 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02002464 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002465
2466
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002467bind-process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002468 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
2469 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2470 yes | yes | yes | yes
2471 Arguments :
2472 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
2473 may be used to override a default value.
2474
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002475 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002476 option may be combined with other numbers.
2477
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002478 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002479 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
2480 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
2481 missing from all processes.
2482
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002483 number The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002484 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02002485 the machine's word size. If a proxy is bound to process
2486 numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it will
2487 either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
2488 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002489
2490 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
2491 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
2492 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
2493 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
2494 and 'even' instances.
2495
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01002496 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
2497 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
2498 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
2499 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002500
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002501 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
2502 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
2503
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02002504 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
2505 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
2506 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
2507
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002508 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
2509 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
2510
2511 Example :
2512 listen app_ip1
2513 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002514 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002515
2516 listen app_ip2
2517 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002518 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002519
2520 listen management
2521 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02002522 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002523
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01002524 listen management
2525 bind 10.0.0.4:80
2526 bind-process 1-4
2527
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02002528 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01002529
2530
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002531block { if | unless } <condition> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002532 Block a layer 7 request if/unless a condition is matched
2533 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2534 no | yes | yes | yes
2535
2536 The HTTP request will be blocked very early in the layer 7 processing
2537 if/unless <condition> is matched. A 403 error will be returned if the request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002538 is blocked. The condition has to reference ACLs (see section 7). This is
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02002539 typically used to deny access to certain sensitive resources if some
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002540 conditions are met or not met. There is no fixed limit to the number of
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002541 "block" statements per instance. To block connections at layer 4 (without
2542 sending a 403 error) see "tcp-request connection reject" and
2543 "tcp-request content reject" rules.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002544
Jarno Huuskonen8c8c3492016-12-28 18:50:29 +02002545 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
2546 "http-request deny" instead.
2547
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002548 Example:
2549 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
2550 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
2551 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +03002552 # block is deprecated. Use http-request deny instead:
2553 #block if invalid_src || local_dst
2554 http-request deny if invalid_src || local_dst
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002555
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03002556 See also : section 7 about ACL usage, "http-request deny",
2557 "http-response deny", "tcp-request connection reject" and
2558 "tcp-request content reject".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002559
2560capture cookie <name> len <length>
2561 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
2562 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2563 no | yes | yes | no
2564 Arguments :
2565 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
2566 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
2567 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
2568 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
2569 and value (eg: ASPSESSIONXXXXX).
2570
2571 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
2572 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
2573 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
2574 right if it exceeds <length>.
2575
2576 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
2577 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
2578 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
2579 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
2580
2581 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
2582 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
2583 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
2584
2585 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
2586 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
2587 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002588 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
2589 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
2590 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002591
2592 Example:
2593 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
2594
2595 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002596 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002597
2598
2599capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002600 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002601 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2602 no | yes | yes | no
2603 Arguments :
2604 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002605 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002606 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
2607 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2608 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2609
2610 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2611 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2612 it exceeds <length>.
2613
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002614 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002615 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
2616 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002617 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
2618 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
2619 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
2620 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002621 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002622 environments to find where the request came from.
2623
2624 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
2625 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
2626 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
2627 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002628
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002629 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
2630 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2631 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2632 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2633 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002634
2635 Example:
2636 capture request header Host len 15
2637 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01002638 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002639
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002640 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002641 about logging.
2642
2643
2644capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002645 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002646 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2647 no | yes | yes | no
2648 Arguments :
2649 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002650 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002651 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
2652 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
2653 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
2654
2655 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
2656 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
2657 it exceeds <length>.
2658
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01002659 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002660 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
2661 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
2662 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01002663 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
2664 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
2665 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
2666 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002667
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01002668 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
2669 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
2670 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
2671 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
2672 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002673
2674 Example:
2675 capture response header Content-length len 9
2676 capture response header Location len 15
2677
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02002678 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002679 about logging.
2680
2681
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002682clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002683 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
2684 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2685 yes | yes | yes | no
2686 Arguments :
2687 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2688 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2689 as explained at the top of this document.
2690
2691 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
2692 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
2693 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
2694 response while it is reading data sent by the server. The value is specified
2695 in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
2696 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
2697 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
2698 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002699 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002700 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
2701 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds).
2702
2703 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
2704 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2705 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2706 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2707 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
2708 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2709
2710 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
2711 Please use "timeout client" instead.
2712
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01002713 See also : "timeout client", "timeout http-request", "timeout server", and
2714 "srvtimeout".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002715
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002716compression algo <algorithm> ...
2717compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002718compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002719 Enable HTTP compression.
2720 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2721 yes | yes | yes | yes
2722 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002723 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
2724 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
2725 offload makes haproxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
2726
2727 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002728 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
2729 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
2730 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002731
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002732 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002733 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002734
2735 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
2736 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
2737 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
2738 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
2739 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002740 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002741
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01002742 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
2743 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
2744 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
2745 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
2746 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
2747 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
2748 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01002749 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002750
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04002751 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01002752 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002753 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
2754 will be no-op: haproxy will see the compressed response and will not
2755 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
2756 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, haproxy will compress the
2757 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02002758
2759 The "offload" setting makes haproxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
2760 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
2761 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
2762 will be done on the single point where haproxy is located. However in some
2763 deployment scenarios, haproxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04002764 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
2765 In that case haproxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
2766 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
2767 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
2768 so that prevents haproxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02002769 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
2770 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002771
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002772 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002773 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
2774 "Accept-Encoding" header
2775 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1
William Lallemandd3002612012-11-26 14:34:47 +01002776 * HTTP status code is not 200
William Lallemand8bb4e342013-12-10 17:28:48 +01002777 * response header "Transfer-Encoding" contains "chunked" (Temporary
2778 Workaround)
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002779 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
2780 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
2781 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
2782 "multipart"
2783 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
2784 header
2785 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
2786 and later
2787 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
2788 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002789
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01002790 Note: The compression does not rewrite Etag headers, and does not emit the
2791 Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01002792
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02002793 Examples :
2794 compression algo gzip
2795 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002796
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02002797
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002798contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002799 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
2800 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2801 yes | no | yes | yes
2802 Arguments :
2803 <timeout> is the timeout value is specified in milliseconds by default, but
2804 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
2805 as explained at the top of this document.
2806
2807 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01002808 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01002809 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002810 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
2811 connect timeout also presets the queue timeout to the same value if this one
2812 has not been specified. Historically, the contimeout was also used to set the
2813 tarpit timeout in a listen section, which is not possible in a pure frontend.
2814
2815 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
2816 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
2817 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
2818 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
2819 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
2820 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
2821
2822 This parameter is provided for backwards compatibility but is currently
2823 deprecated. Please use "timeout connect", "timeout queue" or "timeout tarpit"
2824 instead.
2825
2826 See also : "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout tarpit",
2827 "timeout server", "contimeout".
2828
2829
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02002830cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002831 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
2832 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01002833 [ dynamic ]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002834 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
2835 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
2836 yes | no | yes | yes
2837 Arguments :
2838 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
2839 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
2840 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
2841 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
2842 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
2843 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
2844 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (eg:
2845 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
2846 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
2847
2848 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
2849 server and that haproxy will have to modify its value to set the
2850 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
2851 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
2852 headers is left to the application. The application can then
2853 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002854 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
2855 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
2856 behaviour is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
2857 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
2858 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002859
2860 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002861 be inserted by haproxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002862
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002863 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002864 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
2865 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be remove before
2866 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
2867 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
2868 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
2869 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
2870 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
2871 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
2872 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
2873 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002874
2875 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
2876 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
2877 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
2878 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
2879 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
2880 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
2881 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
2882 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
2883 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01002884 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002885 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
2886 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
2887 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002888
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02002889 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
2890 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
2891 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002892 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
2893 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
2894 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
2895 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02002896 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
2897 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
2898 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002899
2900 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
2901 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
2902 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
2903 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
2904 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
2905 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
2906 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
2907 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
2908 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
2909
2910 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
2911 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
2912 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
2913 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
2914 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
2915 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
2916 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
2917 persistence cookie in the cache.
2918 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
2919
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02002920 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
2921 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
2922 case, if a cookie is found in the response, haproxy will leave it
2923 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
2924 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
2925 emit a cookie with an invalid value (eg: empty) or with a date in
2926 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
2927 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
2928 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
2929 they logout.
2930
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02002931 httponly This option tells haproxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
2932 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
2933 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
2934 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
2935
2936 secure This option tells haproxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
2937 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
2938 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
2939 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
2940 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
2941 this attribute.
2942
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002943 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002944 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01002945 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
2946 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
2947 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
2948 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
2949 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
2950 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02002951
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02002952 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
2953 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
2954 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
2955 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
2956 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
2957 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
2958 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
2959 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2960 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). When
2961 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
2962 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
2963 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
2964 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
2965 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
2966 the site.
2967
2968 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
2969 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
2970 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
2971 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
2972 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
2973 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
2974 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
2975 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
2976 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
2977 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
2978 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
2979 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
2980 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
2981 too long on the same server (eg: after a farm size change). This
2982 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
2983 redispatch after some absolute delay.
2984
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01002985 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
2986 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
2987 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
2988 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
2989 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
2990 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
2991
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002992 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
2993 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
2994 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
2995 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002996
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002997 Examples :
2998 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
2999 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
3000 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02003001 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003002
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02003003 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003004
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003005
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003006declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
3007 Declares a capture slot.
3008 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3009 no | yes | yes | no
3010 Arguments:
3011 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
3012
3013 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
3014 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
3015 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
3016 for use in the response.
3017
3018 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02003019 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003020 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
3021
3022
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003023default-server [param*]
3024 Change default options for a server in a backend
3025 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3026 yes | no | yes | yes
3027 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003028 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
3029 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
3030 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
3031 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003032
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003033 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01003034 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
3035
3036 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003037
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01003038
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003039default_backend <backend>
3040 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
3041 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3042 yes | yes | yes | no
3043 Arguments :
3044 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
3045
3046 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
3047 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
3048 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
3049 will catch all undetermined requests.
3050
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003051 Example :
3052
3053 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
3054 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
3055 default_backend dynamic
3056
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02003057 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003058
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003059
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02003060description <string>
3061 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
3062 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3063 no | yes | yes | yes
3064 Arguments : string
3065
3066 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
3067 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
3068 it describes.
3069 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
3070
3071
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003072disabled
3073 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3074 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3075 yes | yes | yes | yes
3076 Arguments : none
3077
3078 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
3079 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
3080 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
3081 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
3082 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
3083 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
3084 keyword in a "defaults" section.
3085
3086 See also : "enabled"
3087
3088
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003089dispatch <address>:<port>
3090 Set a default server address
3091 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3092 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02003093 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003094
3095 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
3096 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
3097 during start-up.
3098
3099 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
3100 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
3101 possible with normal servers.
3102
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02003103 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003104 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
3105 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
3106 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
3107 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
3108
3109 See also : "server"
3110
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01003111
3112dynamic-cookie-key <string>
3113 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
3114 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3115 yes | no | yes | yes
3116 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
3117
3118 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
3119 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitely
3120 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
3121 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
3122 That way, we can ensure session persistence accross multiple load-balancers,
3123 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02003124
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003125enabled
3126 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
3127 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3128 yes | yes | yes | yes
3129 Arguments : none
3130
3131 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
3132 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
3133
3134 See also : "disabled"
3135
3136
3137errorfile <code> <file>
3138 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3139 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3140 yes | yes | yes | yes
3141 Arguments :
3142 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
CJ Ess108b1dd2015-04-07 12:03:37 -04003143 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
3144 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003145
3146 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003147 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003148 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003149 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3150 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003151
3152 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3153 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3154 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3155
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003156 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3157
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003158 The files are returned verbatim on the TCP socket. This allows any trick such
3159 as redirections to another URL or site, as well as tricks to clean cookies,
3160 force enable or disable caching, etc... The package provides default error
3161 files returning the same contents as default errors.
3162
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003163 The files should not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFSIZE), which
3164 generally is 8 or 16 kB, otherwise they will be truncated. It is also wise
3165 not to put any reference to local contents (eg: images) in order to avoid
3166 loops between the client and HAProxy when all servers are down, causing an
3167 error to be returned instead of an image. For better HTTP compliance, it is
3168 recommended that all header lines end with CR-LF and not LF alone.
3169
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003170 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
3171 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
3172 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01003173 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003174 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
3175
3176 See also : "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
3177
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003178 Example :
3179 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003180 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01003181 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
3182 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
3183
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003184
3185errorloc <code> <url>
3186errorloc302 <code> <url>
3187 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3188 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3189 yes | yes | yes | yes
3190 Arguments :
3191 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Jarno Huuskonen013a84f2017-04-22 11:26:50 +03003192 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
3193 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003194
3195 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3196 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3197 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3198 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3199 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3200
3201 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3202 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3203 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3204
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003205 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3206
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003207 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
3208 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
3209 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
3210 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01003211 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003212 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
3213 request.
3214
3215 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc303"
3216
3217
3218errorloc303 <code> <url>
3219 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
3220 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3221 yes | yes | yes | yes
3222 Arguments :
3223 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Jarno Huuskonen013a84f2017-04-22 11:26:50 +03003224 generating codes 200, 400, 403, 405, 408, 429, 500, 502, 503, and
3225 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003226
3227 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
3228 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
3229 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
3230 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
3231 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (eg: 500).
3232
3233 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
3234 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
3235 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
3236
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02003237 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
3238
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003239 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
3240 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
3241 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
3242 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01003243 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003244
3245 See also : "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
3246
3247
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003248email-alert from <emailaddr>
3249 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
3250 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
3251 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3252 yes | yes | yes | yes
3253
3254 Arguments :
3255
3256 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
3257
3258 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3259 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3260
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003261 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02003262 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
3263 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003264
3265
3266email-alert level <level>
3267 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
3268 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
3269 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3270 yes | yes | yes | yes
3271
3272 Arguments :
3273
3274 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
3275 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
3276 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
3277
3278 By default level is alert
3279
3280 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3281 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3282 for the proxy.
3283
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09003284 Alerts are sent when :
3285
3286 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
3287 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
3288 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
3289 is notice or lower
3290 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
3291 and a health check status update occurs
3292
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003293 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
3294 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003295 section 3.6 about mailers.
3296
3297
3298email-alert mailers <mailersect>
3299 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
3300 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3301 yes | yes | yes | yes
3302
3303 Arguments :
3304
3305 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
3306
3307 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
3308 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3309
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003310 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
3311 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003312
3313
3314email-alert myhostname <hostname>
3315 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
3316 mailers.
3317 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3318 yes | yes | yes | yes
3319
3320 Arguments :
3321
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01003322 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003323
3324 By default the systems hostname is used.
3325
3326 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
3327 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
3328 for the proxy.
3329
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003330 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
3331 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003332
3333
3334email-alert to <emailaddr>
3335 Declare both the recipent address in the envelope and to address in the
3336 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
3337 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3338 yes | yes | yes | yes
3339
3340 Arguments :
3341
3342 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
3343
3344 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
3345 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
3346
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003347 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003348 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
3349
3350
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003351force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
3352 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
3353 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3354 no | yes | yes | yes
3355
3356 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
3357 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
3358 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
3359 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
3360 marked down for maintenance operations.
3361
3362 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
3363 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
3364 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
3365 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
3366 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
3367 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
3368 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
3369 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
3370 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
3371
3372 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
3373 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
3374 is used.
3375
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02003376 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02003377 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003378
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003379
3380filter <name> [param*]
3381 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
3382 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3383 no | yes | yes | yes
3384 Arguments :
3385 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
3386 referenced in section 9.
3387
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003388 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003389 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01003390 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
3391 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003392
3393 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
3394 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
3395
3396 Example:
3397 listen
3398 bind *:80
3399
3400 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
3401 filter compression
3402 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
3403
3404 compression algo gzip
3405 compression offload
3406
3407 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
3408
3409 See also : section 9.
3410
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01003411
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003412fullconn <conns>
3413 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
3414 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3415 yes | no | yes | yes
3416 Arguments :
3417 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
3418 servers use the maximal number of connections.
3419
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003420 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003421 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01003422 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003423 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
3424 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
3425 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
3426 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
3427 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003428 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003429
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003430 Since it's hard to get this value right, haproxy automatically sets it to
3431 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01003432 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
3433 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
3434 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02003435
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003436 Example :
3437 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
3438 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
3439 # connections.
3440 backend dynamic
3441 fullconn 10000
3442 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3443 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
3444
3445 See also : "maxconn", "server"
3446
3447
3448grace <time>
3449 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
3450 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01003451 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003452 Arguments :
3453 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
3454 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
3455 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
3456
3457 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
3458 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003459 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003460 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
3461
3462 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
3463 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
3464 simplify it.
3465
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003466
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003467hash-balance-factor <factor>
3468 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
3469 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3470 yes | no | no | yes
3471 Arguments :
3472 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
3473 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
3474 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
3475
3476 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
3477 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
3478 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
3479 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
3480 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
3481 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
3482 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
3483
3484 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
3485 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
3486 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
3487 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
3488 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
3489
3490 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
3491
3492
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003493hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003494 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
3495 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3496 yes | no | yes | yes
3497 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003498 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
3499 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003500
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003501 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
3502 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
3503 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
3504 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
3505 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
3506 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
3507 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
3508 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
3509 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
3510 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01003511
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003512 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
3513 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
3514 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
3515 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
3516 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
3517 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
3518 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
3519 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
3520 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
3521 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
3522 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
3523 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
3524 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003525 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
3526 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003527
3528 <function> is the hash function to be used :
3529
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003530 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003531 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
3532 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
3533 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003534 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
3535 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
3536 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003537
3538 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
3539 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003540 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
3541 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
3542 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
3543 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
3544
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01003545 wt6 this function was designed for haproxy while testing other
3546 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
3547 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
3548 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
3549 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
3550 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
3551 parameter.
3552
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01003553 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
3554 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
3555 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
3556 used on strings.
3557
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05003558 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
3559
3560 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
3561 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
3562 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
3563 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
3564 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
3565 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
3566 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
3567 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
3568 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
3569 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
3570 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
3571 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003572
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04003573 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
3574 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
3575 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003576
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04003577 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003578
3579
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003580http-check disable-on-404
3581 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
3582 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003583 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003584 Arguments : none
3585
3586 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
3587 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
3588 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
3589 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
3590 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
3591 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
3592 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
3593 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003594 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
3595 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
3596 responses will still be considered as soft-stop.
3597
3598 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check expect"
3599
3600
3601http-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003602 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003603 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02003604 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003605 Arguments :
3606 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
3607 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003608 "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003609 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
3610 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
3611 details on the supported keywords.
3612
3613 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
3614 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
3615 with the usual backslash ('\').
3616
3617 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
3618 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
3619 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
3620 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
3621 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
3622
3623 status <string> : test the exact string match for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003624 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003625 response's status code is exactly this string. If the
3626 "status" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3627 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3628
3629 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003630 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003631 response's status code matches the expression. If the
3632 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3633 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
3634 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
3635
3636 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003637 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003638 response's body contains this exact string. If the
3639 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
3640 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
3641 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
3642 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
3643 specific error appears on the check page (eg: a stack
3644 trace).
3645
3646 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003647 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003648 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
3649 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
3650 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
3651 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
3652 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
3653 error appears on the check page (eg: a stack trace).
3654
3655 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
3656 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
3657 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
3658 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
3659 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
3660 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
3661 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
3662 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
3663
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01003664 Also "http-check expect" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
3665 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, meaning that this
3666 header should not be present in the request provided by "option httpchk".
3667
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003668 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
3669 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
3670
3671 Examples :
3672 # only accept status 200 as valid
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003673 http-check expect status 200
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003674
3675 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003676 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003677
3678 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01003679 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003680
3681 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03003682 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003683
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01003684 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01003685
3686
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003687http-check send-state
3688 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
3689 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3690 yes | no | yes | yes
3691 Arguments : none
3692
3693 When this option is set, haproxy will systematically send a special header
3694 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
3695 how they are seen by haproxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
3696 manipulated without access to haproxy and the operator needs to know whether
3697 haproxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
3698
3699 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
3700 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
3701 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
3702 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
3703 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08003704 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
3705 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
3706 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3707
3708 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
3709 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
3710 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
3711
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01003712 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
3713 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
3714 checked in multiple backends.
3715
3716 - a variable "node" containing the name of the haproxy node, as set in the
3717 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
3718
3719 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
3720 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
3721 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
3722 one fails.
3723
3724 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
3725 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
3726 connections on all servers of the same backend.
3727
3728 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
3729 server's queue.
3730
3731 Example of a header received by the application server :
3732 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
3733 scur=13/22; qcur=0
3734
3735 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404"
3736
Jarno Huuskonen800d1762017-03-06 14:56:36 +02003737http-request { allow | auth [realm <realm>] | redirect <rule> |
3738 tarpit [deny_status <status>] | deny [deny_status <status>] |
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003739 add-header <name> <fmt> | set-header <name> <fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003740 capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003741 del-header <name> | set-nice <nice> | set-log-level <level> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003742 replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
3743 replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt> |
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003744 set-method <fmt> | set-path <fmt> | set-query <fmt> |
3745 set-uri <fmt> | set-tos <tos> | set-mark <mark> |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003746 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3747 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
3748 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Baptiste Assmannbb7e86a2014-09-03 18:29:47 +02003749 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02003750 set-var(<var name>) <expr> |
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01003751 unset-var(<var name>) |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01003752 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02003753 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02003754 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003755 silent-drop |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003756 }
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01003757 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003758 Access control for Layer 7 requests
3759
3760 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3761 no | yes | yes | yes
3762
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003763 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
3764 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
3765 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
3766 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
3767 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01003768
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003769 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
3770 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request
3771 pass the check. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
3772
3773 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
Willy Tarreaube1d34d2016-06-26 19:37:59 +02003774 the request and emits an HTTP 403 error, or optionally the status code
3775 specified as an argument to "deny_status". The list of permitted status
3776 codes is limited to those that can be overridden by the "errorfile"
3777 directive. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003778
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003779 - "tarpit" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks
3780 the request without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit"
3781 or "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the
Jarno Huuskonen800d1762017-03-06 14:56:36 +02003782 client is still connected, an HTTP error 500 (or optionally the status
3783 code specified as an argument to "deny_status") is returned so that the
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003784 client does not suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags
3785 "PT". The goal of the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack
3786 when they're limited on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very
3787 efficient against very dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the
3788 load on firewalls compared to a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly"
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003789 developed robots, it can make things worse by forcing haproxy and the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02003790 front firewall to support insane number of concurrent connections. See
3791 also the "silent-drop" action below.
Willy Tarreauccbcc372012-12-27 12:37:57 +01003792
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003793 - "auth" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds
3794 with an HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid
3795 user name and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An
3796 optional "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm
3797 that is returned with the response (typically the application's name).
3798
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003799 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
3800 This is exactly the same as the "redirect" statement except that it
3801 inserts a redirect rule which can be processed in the middle of other
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01003802 "http-request" rules and that these rules use the "log-format" strings.
3803 See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax.
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01003804
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003805 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
3806 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
3807 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly
3808 useful to pass connection-specific information to the server (eg: the
3809 client's SSL certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This
3810 rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note
3811 that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
3812 the resulting header from a previous rule.
3813
3814 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
3815 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
3816 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
Willy Tarreau85603282015-01-21 20:39:27 +01003817 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so
3818 it is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01003819
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02003820 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
3821 <name>.
3822
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06003823 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
3824 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
3825 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
3826 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
3827 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
3828 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
3829 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
3830 in their value, such as If-Modified-Since and so on.
3831
3832 Example:
3833
3834 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
3835
3836 applied to:
3837
3838 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3839
3840 outputs:
3841
3842 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
3843
3844 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
3845
3846 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
3847 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
3848 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
3849 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
3850 header.
3851
3852 Example:
3853
3854 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
3855
3856 applied to:
3857
3858 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3859
3860 outputs:
3861
3862 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
3863
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01003864 - "set-method" rewrites the request method with the result of the
3865 evaluation of format string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons
3866 for having to do so as this is more likely to break something than to fix
3867 it.
3868
3869 - "set-path" rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of
3870 format string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a
3871 scheme and authority is found before the path, they are left intact as
3872 well. If the request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with
3873 the format. This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of
3874 a path for example. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3875
3876 Example :
3877 # prepend the host name before the path
3878 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
3879
3880 - "set-query" rewrites the request's query string which appears after the
3881 first question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format
3882 string <fmt>. The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the
3883 request doesn't contain a question mark and the new value is not empty,
3884 then one is added at the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If
3885 a question mark was present, it will never be removed even if the value
3886 is empty. This can be used to add or remove parameters from the query
3887 string. See also "set-query" and "set-uri".
3888
3889 Example :
3890 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
3891 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
3892
3893 - "set-uri" rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of
3894 format string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all
3895 replaced at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies,
3896 or to perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts
3897 between the path and the query string. See also "set-path" and
3898 "set-query".
3899
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02003900 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
3901 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
3902 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
3903 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
3904 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
3905 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
3906 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
3907 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
3908
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02003909 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
3910 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
3911 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
3912 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
3913 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
3914 another equipment.
3915
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02003916 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
3917 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
3918 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
3919 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
3920 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
3921 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
3922 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
3923 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
3924
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02003925 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
3926 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
3927 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
3928 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
3929 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
3930 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
3931 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
3932 admin privileges.
3933
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02003934 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3935 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3936 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3937 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
3938 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3939 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3940 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
3941 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3942
3943 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
3944 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
3945 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3946 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3947 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
3948 can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3949
3950 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3951 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3952 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
3953 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
3954 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
3955 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3956
3957 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
3958 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
3959 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
3960 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
3961 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
3962 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
3963 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
3964 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
3965 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
3966
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003967 - capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ] :
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02003968 captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts
3969 it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
3970 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear
3971 next to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in
3972 the logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules
3973 to feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
3974 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
3975 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
3976 request header" for more information.
3977
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003978 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store
3979 the captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful
3980 to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous
3981 directive "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01003982 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
3983 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02003984
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02003985 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
3986 enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules
3987 do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. Three sets of
3988 counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The first
3989 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
3990 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
3991 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
3992 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
3993 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
3994 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
3995 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
3996 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
3997
3998 These actions take one or two arguments :
3999 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
4000 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
4001 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
4002 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
4003
4004 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
4005 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
4006 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
4007 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
4008
4009 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
4010 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
4011 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
4012 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
4013 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
4014 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
4015 been started. As an exception, connection counters and request counters
4016 are systematically updated so that they reflect useful information.
4017
4018 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
4019 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
4020 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
4021 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
4022 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
4023
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004024 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
4025 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
4026 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
4027 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
4028 continues.
4029
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004030 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
4031 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
4032 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
4033 the actions evaluation continues.
4034
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004035 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr> :
4036 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4037 inline.
4038
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004039 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
4040 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01004041 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004042 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4043 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004044 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004045 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004046 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004047 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4048 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004049 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004050 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004051 and '_'.
4052
4053 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4054 followed by some converters.
4055
4056 Example:
4057
4058 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
4059
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004060 - unset-var(<var-name>) :
4061 Is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
4062
4063 Example:
4064
4065 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
4066
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004067 - set-src <expr> :
4068 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
4069 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP,
4070 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
4071 source IP for privacy.
4072
4073 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4074 followed by some converters.
4075
4076 Example:
4077
4078 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
4079 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
4080
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004081 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
4082 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02004083
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004084 - set-src-port <expr> :
4085 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
4086 expression.
4087
4088 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4089 followed by some converters.
4090
4091 Example:
4092
4093 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
4094 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
4095
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004096 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
4097 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
4098 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02004099
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004100 - set-dst <expr> :
4101 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
4102 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination
4103 IP, but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask
4104 the IP for privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
4105 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
4106
4107 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4108 followed by some converters.
4109
4110 Example:
4111
4112 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
4113 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
4114
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004115 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
4116 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
4117
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02004118 - set-dst-port <expr> :
4119 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
4120 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
4121 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
4122
4123 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4124 followed by some converters.
4125
4126 Example:
4127
4128 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
4129 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
4130
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02004131 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
4132 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
4133 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
4134
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004135 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4136 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4137 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4138 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4139 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4140 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4141 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4142 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4143 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4144 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4145 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4146 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4147 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4148 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4149 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4150 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4151
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004152 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
4153
4154 It is important to know that http-request rules are processed very early in
4155 the HTTP processing, just after "block" rules and before "reqdel" or "reqrep"
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004156 or "reqadd" rules. That way, headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are
4157 visible by almost all further ACL rules.
4158
4159 Using "reqadd"/"reqdel"/"reqrep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4160 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4161 delete headers, you can still use "reqdel". Also please use
4162 "http-request deny/allow/tarpit" instead of "reqdeny"/"reqpass"/"reqtarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004163
4164 Example:
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004165 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
4166 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
4167 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004168
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004169 http-request allow if nagios
4170 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
4171 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
4172 http-request deny
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004173
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004174 Example:
4175 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01004176 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01004177
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004178 Example:
4179 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
4180 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
Willy Tarreaufca42612015-08-27 17:15:05 +02004181 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01004182 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
4183 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
4184 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
4185 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
4186 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
4187 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
4188
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004189 Example:
4190 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
4191 acl add path /addacl
4192 acl del path /delacl
4193
4194 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4195
4196 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
4197 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
4198
4199 Example:
4200 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4201 acl setmap path /setmap
4202 acl delmap path /delmap
4203
4204 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4205
4206 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
4207 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
4208
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02004209 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
4210 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01004211
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004212http-response { allow | deny | add-header <name> <fmt> | set-nice <nice> |
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004213 capture <sample> id <id> | redirect <rule> |
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004214 set-header <name> <fmt> | del-header <name> |
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004215 replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
4216 replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt> |
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004217 set-status <status> [reason <str>] |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004218 set-log-level <level> | set-mark <mark> | set-tos <tos> |
4219 add-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
4220 del-acl(<file name>) <key fmt> |
4221 del-map(<file name>) <key fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01004222 set-map(<file name>) <key fmt> <value fmt> |
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004223 set-var(<var-name>) <expr> |
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004224 unset-var(<var-name>) |
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004225 { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] |
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004226 sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) |
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004227 sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> |
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004228 silent-drop |
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004229 }
Lukas Tribus2dd1d1a2013-06-19 23:34:41 +02004230 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004231 Access control for Layer 7 responses
4232
4233 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4234 no | yes | yes | yes
4235
4236 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
4237 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
4238 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
4239 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
4240 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
4241 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
4242
4243 The first keyword is the rule's action. Currently supported actions include :
4244 - "allow" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response
4245 pass the check. No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the
4246 current section.
4247
4248 - "deny" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects
4249 the response and emits an HTTP 502 error. No further "http-response"
4250 rules are evaluated.
4251
4252 - "add-header" appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in
4253 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format
4254 rules (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send
4255 a cookie to a client for example, or to pass some internal information.
4256 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
4257 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might
4258 reuse the resulting header from a previous rule.
4259
4260 - "set-header" does the same as "add-header" except that the header name
4261 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
4262 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
4263 external users.
4264
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02004265 - "del-header" removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in
4266 <name>.
4267
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06004268 - "replace-header" matches the regular expression in all occurrences of
4269 header field <name> according to <match-regex>, and replaces them with
4270 the <replace-fmt> argument. Format characters are allowed in replace-fmt
4271 and work like in <fmt> arguments in "add-header". The match is only
4272 case-sensitive. It is important to understand that this action only
4273 considers whole header lines, regardless of the number of values they
4274 may contain. This usage is suited to headers naturally containing commas
4275 in their value, such as Set-Cookie, Expires and so on.
4276
4277 Example:
4278
4279 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
4280
4281 applied to:
4282
4283 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4284
4285 outputs:
4286
4287 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
4288
4289 assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
4290
4291 - "replace-value" works like "replace-header" except that it matches the
4292 regex against every comma-delimited value of the header field <name>
4293 instead of the entire header. This is suited for all headers which are
4294 allowed to carry more than one value. An example could be the Accept
4295 header.
4296
4297 Example:
4298
4299 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
4300
4301 applied to:
4302
4303 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
4304
4305 outputs:
4306
4307 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
4308
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004309 - "set-status" replaces the response status code with <status> which must
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004310 be an integer between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be
4311 provided defined by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code
4312 will be used as a fallback.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004313
4314 Example:
4315
4316 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
4317 http-response set-status 431
Robin H. Johnson52f5db22017-01-01 13:10:52 -08004318 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
4319 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02004320
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02004321 - "set-nice" sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
4322 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
4323 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
4324 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
4325 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more
4326 important than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of
4327 some requests, or lower the priority of non-important requests. Using
4328 this setting without prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
4329
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02004330 - "set-log-level" is used to change the log level of the current request
4331 when a certain condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels
4332 (see the "log" keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables
4333 logging for this request. This rule is not final so the last matching
4334 rule wins. This rule can be useful to disable health checks coming from
4335 another equipment.
4336
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02004337 - "set-tos" is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to
4338 the client to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
4339 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
4340 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note
4341 that only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower
4342 bits are always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behaviour on
4343 border routers based on some information from the request. See RFC 2474,
4344 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
4345
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02004346 - "set-mark" is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the
4347 client to the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This
4348 value is an unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and
4349 by the routing table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal
4350 format (prefixed by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to
4351 take a different route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk
4352 downloads). This works on Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires
4353 admin privileges.
4354
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004355 - "add-acl" is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4356 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4357 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4358 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It
4359 performs a lookup in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4360 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4361 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the
4362 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4363
4364 - "del-acl" is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded
4365 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be
4366 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4367 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4368 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but
4369 can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4370
4371 - "del-map" is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4372 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4373 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>,
4374 which follows log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
4375 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
4376 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4377
4378 - "set-map" is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded
4379 from a file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be
4380 updated is passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>,
4381 which follows log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>,
4382 which follows log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
4383 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
4384 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
4385 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
4386 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
4387
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004388 - capture <sample> id <id> :
4389 captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and converts
4390 it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
4391 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
4392 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
4393 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
4394 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
4395 response header" for more information.
4396
4397 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing
4398 the string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
4399 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by
4400 a previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
4401 keyword.
Baptiste Assmanne9544932015-11-03 23:31:35 +01004402 If the slot <id> doesn't exist, then HAProxy fails parsing the
4403 configuration to prevent unexpected behavior at run time.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02004404
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02004405 - "redirect" : this performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
4406 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
4407 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible
4408 on the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When
4409 a redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server
4410 are closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
4411
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004412 - set-var(<var-name>) expr:
4413 Is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
4414 inline.
4415
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004416 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
4417 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01004418 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004419 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
4420 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004421 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004422 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004423 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01004424 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
4425 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004426 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01004427 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
4428 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02004429
4430 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
4431 followed by some converters.
4432
4433 Example:
4434
4435 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
4436
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01004437 - unset-var(<var-name>) :
4438 Is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
4439
4440 Example:
4441
4442 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
4443
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08004444 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
4445 enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer to
4446 "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
4447 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make
4448 use of samples in response (eg. res.*, status etc.) and samples below
4449 Layer 6 (eg. ssl related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is
4450 not supported, haproxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
4451
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02004452 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
4453 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
4454 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
4455 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
4456 continues.
4457
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02004458 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
4459 This action increments the GPC0 counter according with the sticky counter
4460 designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and
4461 the actions evaluation continues.
4462
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02004463 - "silent-drop" : this stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the
4464 client-facing connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way
4465 that tries to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then
4466 that the client still sees an established connection while there's none
4467 on HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
4468 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
4469 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and slow
4470 down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact of using
4471 this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the client and
4472 HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep the
4473 established connection for a long time and may suffer from this action.
4474 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR
4475 socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other
4476 systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't
4477 pass the first router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do
4478 not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
4479
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004480 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
4481
Godbach09250262013-07-02 01:19:15 +08004482 It is important to know that http-response rules are processed very early in
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004483 the HTTP processing, before "rspdel" or "rsprep" or "rspadd" rules. That way,
4484 headers added by "add-header"/"set-header" are visible by almost all further ACL
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004485 rules.
4486
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08004487 Using "rspadd"/"rspdel"/"rsprep" to manipulate request headers is discouraged
4488 in newer versions (>= 1.5). But if you need to use regular expression to
4489 delete headers, you can still use "rspdel". Also please use
4490 "http-response deny" instead of "rspdeny".
4491
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02004492 Example:
4493 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
4494
4495 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
4496
4497 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4498 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
4499
4500 Example:
4501 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
4502
4503 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
4504
4505 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
4506 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
4507
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02004508 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
4509 ACL usage.
4510
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02004511
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02004512http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
4513 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
4514
4515 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4516 yes | no | yes | yes
4517
4518 By default, a connection established between haproxy and the backend server
4519 belongs to the session that initiated it. The downside is that between the
4520 response and the next request, the connection remains idle and is not used.
4521 In many cases for performance reasons it is desirable to make it possible to
4522 reuse these idle connections to serve other requests from different sessions.
4523 This directive allows to tune this behaviour.
4524
4525 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
4526
4527 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This is
4528 the default choice. It may be enforced to cancel a different
4529 strategy inherited from a defaults section or for
4530 troubleshooting. For example, if an old bogus application
4531 considers that multiple requests over the same connection come
4532 from the same client and it is not possible to fix the
4533 application, it may be desirable to disable connection sharing
4534 in a single backend. An example of such an application could
4535 be an old haproxy using cookie insertion in tunnel mode and
4536 not checking any request past the first one.
4537
4538 - "safe" : this is the recommended strategy. The first request of a
4539 session is always sent over its own connection, and only
4540 subsequent requests may be dispatched over other existing
4541 connections. This ensures that in case the server closes the
4542 connection when the request is being sent, the browser can
4543 decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly equivalent to
4544 regular keep-alive, there should be no side effects.
4545
4546 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
4547 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
4548 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
4549 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
4550 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
4551 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
4552 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
4553 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
4554 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweights the
4555 downsides of rare connection failures.
4556
4557 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
4558 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
4559 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
4560 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
4561 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
4562 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
4563 consistent behaviour and will benefit from the connection
4564 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
4565 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
4566 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
4567 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
4568 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
4569
4570 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
4571 connection properties and compatiblities. Specifically :
4572 - connections made with "usesrc" followed by a client-dependant value
4573 ("client", "clientip", "hdr_ip") are marked private and never shared ;
4574
4575 - connections sent to a server with a TLS SNI extension are marked private
4576 and are never shared ;
4577
4578 - connections receiving a status code 401 or 407 expect some authentication
4579 to be sent in return. Due to certain bogus authentication schemes (such
4580 as NTLM) relying on the connection, these connections are marked private
4581 and are never shared ;
4582
4583 No connection pool is involved, once a session dies, the last idle connection
4584 it was attached to is deleted at the same time. This ensures that connections
4585 may not last after all sessions are closed.
4586
4587 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
4588 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
4589 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
4590
4591 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
4592
4593
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05004594http-send-name-header [<header>]
4595 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
4596
4597 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4598 yes | no | yes | yes
4599
4600 Arguments :
4601
4602 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
4603
4604 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the name of the target
4605 server to be added to the headers of an HTTP request. The name
4606 is added with the header string proved.
4607
4608 See also : "server"
4609
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004610id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02004611 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
4612 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4613 no | yes | yes | yes
4614 Arguments : none
4615
4616 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
4617 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
4618 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01004619
4620
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004621ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
4622 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
4623 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4624 no | yes | yes | yes
4625
4626 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
4627 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
4628 and running).
4629
4630 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
4631 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
4632 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03004633 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004634 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
4635
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004636 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
4637 "unless" condition is met.
4638
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03004639 Example:
4640 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
4641 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
4642 ignore-persist if url_static
4643
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004644 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
4645
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004646load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
4647 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
4648 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4649 yes | no | yes | yes
4650
4651 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
4652 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
4653 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
4654 reload occured. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
4655 to tell haproxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
4656 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
4657 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
4658 over the stats socket and redirect output.
4659
4660 The format of the file is versionned and is very specific. To understand it,
4661 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02004662 9.2 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004663
4664 Arguments:
4665 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
4666 named "server-state-file".
4667
4668 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
4669 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
4670 name is used as a file name.
4671
4672 none don't load any stat for this backend
4673
4674 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01004675 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
4676 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
4677 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
4678 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (eg: /etc/hosts)
4679 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004680
4681 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
4682 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
4683
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004684 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004685
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004686 global
4687 stats socket /tmp/socket
4688 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004689
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004690 defaults
4691 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004692
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004693 backend bk
4694 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4695 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004696
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004697
4698 Then one can run :
4699
4700 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
4701
4702 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
4703
4704 1
4705 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4706 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4707 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4708
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004709 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004710
4711 global
4712 stats socket /tmp/socket
4713 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
4714
4715 defaults
4716 load-server-state-from-file local
4717
4718 backend bk
4719 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
4720 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
4721
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02004722
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02004723 Then one can run :
4724
4725 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
4726
4727 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
4728
4729 1
4730 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
4731 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4732 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
4733
4734 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
4735 "show servers state"
4736
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02004737
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004738log global
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004739log <address> [len <length>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004740no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004741 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
4742 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4743 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004744
4745 Prefix :
4746 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
4747 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
4748 prefix does not allow arguments.
4749
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004750 Arguments :
4751 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
4752 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
4753 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
4754 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
4755 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
4756 parameter.
4757
4758 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
4759 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
4760
4761 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
4762 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4763 standard syslog port).
4764
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01004765 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
4766 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
4767 standard syslog port).
4768
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004769 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
4770 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
4771 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
4772 appropriately writeable).
4773
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004774 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4775 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004776
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02004777 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
4778 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
4779 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
4780 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
4781 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
4782 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
4783 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
4784 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
4785 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
4786 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
4787 long captures or JSON-formated logs may require larger values.
4788
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004789 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
4790
4791 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
4792 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
4793 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
4794
4795 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
4796 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
4797 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004798 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
4799 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
4800 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
4801 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
4802 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004803
4804 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4805
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02004806 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
4807 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
4808 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004809
4810 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
4811 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
4812 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
4813 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
4814
4815 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
4816 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004817
4818 Example :
4819 log global
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02004820 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
4821 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output level
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004822 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004823
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004824
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004825log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004826 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
4827 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4828 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004829
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01004830 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
4831 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
4832 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
4833 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
4834 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01004835
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02004836 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
4837 "option httplog" directives.
4838
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02004839log-format-sd <string>
4840 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
4841 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4842 yes | yes | yes | no
4843
4844 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
4845 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
4846 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
4847 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
4848 which covers the log format string in depth.
4849
4850 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
4851 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
4852
4853 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
4854 log format to "rfc5424".
4855
4856 Example :
4857 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
4858
4859
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01004860log-tag <string>
4861 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
4862 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4863 yes | yes | yes | yes
4864
4865 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
4866 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
4867 from the command line, which usually is "haproxy". Sometimes it can be useful
4868 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
4869 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
4870 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
4871 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
4872 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
4873 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004874
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02004875max-keep-alive-queue <value>
4876 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
4877 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4878 yes | no | yes | yes
4879
4880 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
4881 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
4882 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
4883 servers.
4884
4885 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
4886 connections at which haproxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
4887 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
4888 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
4889 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
4890 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (eg: local static server can
4891 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
4892 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
4893 picking a different server.
4894
4895 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
4896 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
4897 even if they have to be queued.
4898
4899 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
4900 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
4901
4902
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004903maxconn <conns>
4904 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
4905 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4906 yes | yes | yes | no
4907 Arguments :
4908 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
4909 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
4910 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
4911 closes.
4912
4913 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
4914 very high so that haproxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
4915 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
4916 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01004917 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
4918 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
4919 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
4920 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004921
4922 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
4923 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
4924 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
4925
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02004926 By default, this value is set to 2000.
4927
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004928 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
4929
4930
4931mode { tcp|http|health }
4932 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
4933 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4934 yes | yes | yes | yes
4935 Arguments :
4936 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
4937 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
4938 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
4939 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
4940
4941 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
4942 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
4943 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
4944 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
4945 brings HAProxy most of its value.
4946
4947 health The instance will work in "health" mode. It will just reply "OK"
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02004948 to incoming connections and close the connection. Alternatively,
4949 If the "httpchk" option is set, "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" will be sent
4950 instead. Nothing will be logged in either case. This mode is used
4951 to reply to external components health checks. This mode is
4952 deprecated and should not be used anymore as it is possible to do
4953 the same and even better by combining TCP or HTTP modes with the
4954 "monitor" keyword.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004955
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004956 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
4957 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
4958 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004959
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004960 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004961 defaults http_instances
4962 mode http
4963
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004964 See also : "monitor", "monitor-net"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004965
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004966
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01004967monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004968 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004969 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4970 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004971 Arguments :
4972 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
4973 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004974 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004975 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
4976 backend and its backup.
4977
4978 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
4979 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
4980 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
4981 servers in a list of backends.
4982
4983 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
4984 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
4985 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
4986 conditions above is met, haproxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
4987 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
4988 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
4989 haproxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004990 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
4991 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004992
4993 Example:
4994 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004995 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004996 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
4997 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
4998 monitor-uri /site_alive
4999 monitor fail if site_dead
5000
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02005001 See also : "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005002
5003
5004monitor-net <source>
5005 Declare a source network which is limited to monitor requests
5006 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5007 yes | yes | yes | no
5008 Arguments :
5009 <source> is the source IPv4 address or network which will only be able to
5010 get monitor responses to any request. It can be either an IPv4
5011 address, a host name, or an address followed by a slash ('/')
5012 followed by a mask.
5013
5014 In TCP mode, any connection coming from a source matching <source> will cause
5015 the connection to be immediately closed without any log. This allows another
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005016 equipment to probe the port and verify that it is still listening, without
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005017 forwarding the connection to a remote server.
5018
5019 In HTTP mode, a connection coming from a source matching <source> will be
5020 accepted, the following response will be sent without waiting for a request,
5021 then the connection will be closed : "HTTP/1.0 200 OK". This is normally
5022 enough for any front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005023 running without forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that this
5024 response is sent in raw format, without any transformation. This is important
5025 as it means that it will not be SSL-encrypted on SSL listeners.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005026
Willy Tarreau82569f92012-09-27 23:48:56 +02005027 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after tcp-request connection
5028 ACLs which are the only ones able to block them. These connections are short
5029 lived and never wait for any data from the client. They cannot be logged, and
5030 it is the intended purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to
5031 an upper component, nothing more. Please note that "monitor fail" rules do
5032 not apply to connections intercepted by "monitor-net".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005033
Willy Tarreau95cd2832010-03-04 23:36:33 +01005034 Last, please note that only one "monitor-net" statement can be specified in
5035 a frontend. If more than one is found, only the last one will be considered.
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02005036
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005037 Example :
5038 # addresses .252 and .253 are just probing us.
5039 frontend www
5040 monitor-net 192.168.0.252/31
5041
5042 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-uri"
5043
5044
5045monitor-uri <uri>
5046 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
5047 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5048 yes | yes | yes | no
5049 Arguments :
5050 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
5051 health status instead of forwarding the request.
5052
5053 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
5054 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
5055 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
5056 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
5057 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
5058 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
5059 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
5060 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
5061
5062 Monitor requests are processed very early. It is not possible to block nor
5063 divert them using ACLs. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
5064 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
5065 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
5066 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
5067 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
5068
5069 Example :
5070 # Use /haproxy_test to report haproxy's status
5071 frontend www
5072 mode http
5073 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
5074
5075 See also : "monitor fail", "monitor-net"
5076
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005077
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005078option abortonclose
5079no option abortonclose
5080 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
5081 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5082 yes | no | yes | yes
5083 Arguments : none
5084
5085 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
5086 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
5087 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
5088 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005089 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005090 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
5091 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
5092 encountered while delivering the response.
5093
5094 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
5095 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
5096 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
5097 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
5098 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
5099 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005100 support this behaviour (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005101 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005102 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005103 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
5104 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
5105 still not served and not pollute the servers.
5106
5107 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behaviour using the option
5108 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behaviour is HTTP
5109 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
5110 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
5111 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
5112 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
5113 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
5114 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005115 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005116
5117 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5118 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5119
5120 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
5121
5122
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005123option accept-invalid-http-request
5124no option accept-invalid-http-request
5125 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
5126 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5127 yes | yes | yes | no
5128 Arguments : none
5129
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005130 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005131 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
5132 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
5133 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5134 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5135 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5136 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5137 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005138 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
5139 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
5140 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
5141 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
5142 not allowed at all. Haproxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005143 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02005144 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
5145 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
5146 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005147
5148 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5149 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5150 been confirmed.
5151
5152 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5153 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01005154 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
5155 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005156 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5157
5158 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5159 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5160
5161 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
5162 stats socket.
5163
5164
5165option accept-invalid-http-response
5166no option accept-invalid-http-response
5167 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
5168 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5169 yes | no | yes | yes
5170 Arguments : none
5171
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005172 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005173 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
5174 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behaviour as such
5175 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
5176 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
5177 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
5178 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
5179 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02005180 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
5181 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
5182 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02005183
5184 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
5185 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
5186 been confirmed.
5187
5188 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
5189 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
5190 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
5191 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
5192
5193 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5194 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5195
5196 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
5197 stats socket.
5198
5199
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005200option allbackups
5201no option allbackups
5202 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
5203 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5204 yes | no | yes | yes
5205 Arguments : none
5206
5207 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
5208 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
5209 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
5210 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
5211 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
5212 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
5213 order between the backup servers anymore.
5214
5215 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
5216 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
5217
5218 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5219 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5220
5221
5222option checkcache
5223no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08005224 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005225 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5226 yes | no | yes | yes
5227 Arguments : none
5228
5229 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
5230 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005231 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005232 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
5233 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02005234 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005235
5236 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005237 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005238 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005239 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
5240 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005241 to the client are :
5242 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005243 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 206, 300, 301, 410,
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005244 provided that the server has not set a "Cache-control: public" header ;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005245 - all those that come from a POST request, provided that the server has not
5246 set a 'Cache-Control: public' header ;
5247 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
5248 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
5249 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
5250 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
5251 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
5252 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
5253 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
5254 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
5255 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
5256
5257 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005258 just as if it was from an "rspdeny" filter, with an "HTTP 502 bad gateway".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005259 The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the response
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005260 during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in the logs so
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005261 that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
5262
5263 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
5264 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01005265 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005266 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviours.
5267
5268 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5269 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5270
5271
5272option clitcpka
5273no option clitcpka
5274 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
5275 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5276 yes | yes | yes | no
5277 Arguments : none
5278
5279 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
5280 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
5281 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
5282 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
5283
5284 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
5285 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
5286 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
5287 operating system and its tuning parameters.
5288
5289 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
5290 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
5291 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
5292 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
5293 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
5294
5295 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
5296
5297 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
5298 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
5299 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
5300
5301 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5302 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5303
5304 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
5305
5306
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005307option contstats
5308 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
5309 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5310 yes | yes | yes | no
5311 Arguments : none
5312
5313 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
5314 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
5315 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
5316 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from haproxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01005317 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
5318 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
5319 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
5320 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
5321 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005322
5323
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005324option dontlog-normal
5325no option dontlog-normal
5326 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
5327 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5328 yes | yes | yes | no
5329 Arguments : none
5330
5331 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
5332 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
5333 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
5334 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
5335 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
5336 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
5337 logged.
5338
5339 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
5340 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
5341 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
5342
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005343 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02005344 logging.
5345
5346
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005347option dontlognull
5348no option dontlognull
5349 Enable or disable logging of null connections
5350 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5351 yes | yes | yes | no
5352 Arguments : none
5353
5354 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
5355 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
5356 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
5357 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
5358 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
5359 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005360 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
5361 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
5362 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005363
5364 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
5365 environments (eg: internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
5366 would not be logged.
5367
5368 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5369 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5370
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005371 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-net", "monitor-uri", and
5372 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005373
5374
5375option forceclose
5376no option forceclose
5377 Enable or disable active connection closing after response is transferred.
5378 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaua31e5df2009-12-30 01:10:35 +01005379 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005380 Arguments : none
5381
5382 Some HTTP servers do not necessarily close the connections when they receive
5383 the "Connection: close" set by "option httpclose", and if the client does not
5384 close either, then the connection remains open till the timeout expires. This
5385 causes high number of simultaneous connections on the servers and shows high
5386 global session times in the logs.
5387
5388 When this happens, it is possible to use "option forceclose". It will
Willy Tarreau82eeaf22009-12-29 12:09:05 +01005389 actively close the outgoing server channel as soon as the server has finished
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005390 to respond and release some resources earlier than with "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005391
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005392 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
5393 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
5394 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
5395
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005396 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5397 http-server-close", "option http-keep-alive", or "option http-tunnel".
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005398
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005399 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5400 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5401
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005402 See also : "option httpclose" and "option http-pretend-keepalive"
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01005403
5404
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005405option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005406 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
5407 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5408 yes | yes | yes | yes
5409 Arguments :
5410 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
5411 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005412 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005413 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005414
5415 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
5416 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
5417 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
5418 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
5419 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
5420 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
5421 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005422 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
5423 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
5424 possible that the client has already brought one.
5425
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005426 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005427 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01005428 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (eg: stunnel),
5429 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005430 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (eg: Zeus Web Servers
5431 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005432
5433 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
5434 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
5435 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
5436 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
5437 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
5438 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
5439 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
5440
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005441 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
5442 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
5443 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching haproxy
5444 are under the control of the end-user.
5445
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005446 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005447 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
5448 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005449 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
5450 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
5451 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005452
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02005453 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005454 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
5455 frontend www
5456 mode http
5457 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
5458
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02005459 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
5460 backend www
5461 mode http
5462 option forwardfor header X-Client
5463
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02005464 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005465 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005466
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005467
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005468option http-buffer-request
5469no option http-buffer-request
5470 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
5471 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5472 yes | yes | yes | yes
5473 Arguments : none
5474
5475 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
5476 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
5477 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
5478 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
5479 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
5480 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
5481 body is received, or the request buffer is full, or the first chunk is
5482 complete in case of chunked encoding. It can have undesired side effects with
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005483 some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered transmissions between
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005484 the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely not be used by
5485 default.
5486
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01005487 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005488
5489
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02005490option http-ignore-probes
5491no option http-ignore-probes
5492 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
5493 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5494 yes | yes | yes | no
5495 Arguments : none
5496
5497 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
5498 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
5499 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
5500 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
5501 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
5502 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
5503 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
5504 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
5505 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
5506 was received over a connection before it was closed ;
5507 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation ;
5508 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
5509
5510 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
5511 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
5512 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
5513 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
5514 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
5515 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
5516 are often the only way to detect them.
5517
5518 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5519 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5520
5521 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
5522
5523
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005524option http-keep-alive
5525no option http-keep-alive
5526 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
5527 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5528 yes | yes | yes | yes
5529 Arguments : none
5530
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005531 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5532 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5533 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
5534 start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such as
5535 "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5536 "option http-tunnel". This option allows to set back the keep-alive mode,
5537 which can be useful when another mode was used in a defaults section.
5538
5539 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
5540 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005541 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
5542 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
5543 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
5544 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
5545 situations where this option may be useful :
5546
5547 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
5548 instead of requests (eg: NTLM authentication)
5549
5550 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
5551 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
5552
5553 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
5554 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
5555 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
5556 request.
5557
5558 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
5559 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005560 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
5561 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
5562 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005563
5564 In general it is preferred to use "option http-server-close" with application
5565 servers, and some static servers might benefit from "option http-keep-alive".
5566
5567 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5568 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5569 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5570 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
5571 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5572 not set.
5573
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005574 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option
5575 http-server-close", "option forceclose" or "option http-tunnel". When backend
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005576 and frontend options differ, all of these 4 options have precedence over
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005577 "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005578
5579 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01005580 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
5581 "option httpclose", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005582
5583
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005584option http-no-delay
5585no option http-no-delay
5586 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
5587 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5588 yes | yes | yes | yes
5589 Arguments : none
5590
5591 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
5592 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
5593 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
5594 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
5595 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
5596 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
5597 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
5598 haproxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
5599 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
5600 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
5601 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
5602 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
5603 affected.
5604
5605 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
5606 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
5607 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
5608 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
5609 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
5610 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
5611 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
5612 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
5613 latency environments.
5614
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02005615 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
5616
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02005617
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005618option http-pretend-keepalive
5619no option http-pretend-keepalive
5620 Define whether haproxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
5621 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5622 yes | yes | yes | yes
5623 Arguments : none
5624
5625 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose", haproxy
5626 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
5627 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
5628 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
5629 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents haproxy from
5630 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
5631 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
5632 consider the response complete.
5633
5634 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", haproxy will make the server
5635 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
5636 to the abnormal undesired above. When haproxy gets the whole response, it
5637 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
5638 "forceclose" option. That way the client gets a normal response and the
5639 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
5640
5641 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
5642 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
5643 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
5644 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
5645 worth noting that when this option is enabled, haproxy will have slightly
5646 less work to do. So if haproxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
5647 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
5648
5649 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5650 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005651 This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will cause
Willy Tarreau22a95342010-09-29 14:31:41 +02005652 keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to the
5653 client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005654
5655 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5656 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5657
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005658 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close", and
5659 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02005660
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005661
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005662option http-server-close
5663no option http-server-close
5664 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
5665 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5666 yes | yes | yes | yes
5667 Arguments : none
5668
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005669 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5670 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5671 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5672 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5673 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5674 "option http-tunnel". Setting "option http-server-close" enables HTTP
5675 connection-close mode on the server side while keeping the ability to support
5676 HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the client side. This provides the lowest
5677 latency on the client side (slow network) and the fastest session reuse on
5678 the server side to save server resources, similarly to "option forceclose".
5679 It also permits non-keepalive capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00005680 to the clients if they conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005681 that some servers do not always conform to those requirements when they see
5682 "Connection: close" in the request. The effect will be that keep-alive will
5683 never be used. A workaround consists in enabling "option
5684 http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005685
5686 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
5687 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
5688 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
5689 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01005690 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
5691 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005692
5693 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5694 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005695 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose", "option forceclose",
5696 "option http-tunnel" or "option http-keep-alive". Please check section 4
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005697 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when frontend and
5698 backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005699
5700 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5701 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5702
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005703 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01005704 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5705 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01005706
5707
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005708option http-tunnel
5709no option http-tunnel
5710 Disable or enable HTTP connection processing after first transaction
5711 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5712 yes | yes | yes | yes
5713 Arguments : none
5714
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005715 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5716 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5717 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5718 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
5719 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
5720 "option http-tunnel".
5721
5722 Option "http-tunnel" disables any HTTP processing past the first request and
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005723 the first response. This is the mode which was used by default in versions
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005724 1.0 to 1.5-dev21. It is the mode with the lowest processing overhead, which
5725 is normally not needed anymore unless in very specific cases such as when
5726 using an in-house protocol that looks like HTTP but is not compatible, or
5727 just to log one request per client in order to reduce log size. Note that
5728 everything which works at the HTTP level, including header parsing/addition,
5729 cookie processing or content switching will only work for the first request
5730 and will be ignored after the first response.
Willy Tarreau02bce8b2014-01-30 00:15:28 +01005731
5732 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5733 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5734
5735 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close",
5736 "option httpclose", "option http-keep-alive", and
5737 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
5738
5739
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005740option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01005741no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005742 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
5743 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5744 yes | yes | yes | no
5745 Arguments : none
5746
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00005747 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005748 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
5749 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
5750 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
5751 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
5752 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
5753 haproxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
5754
5755 By setting this option in a frontend, haproxy can automatically switch to use
5756 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005757 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
5758 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
5759 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005760
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01005761 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
5762 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
5763 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
5764 front of an existing proxy.
5765
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01005766 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
5767
5768 See also : "option httpclose", "option forceclose" and "option
5769 http-server-close".
5770
5771
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005772option httpchk
5773option httpchk <uri>
5774option httpchk <method> <uri>
5775option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
5776 Enable HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
5777 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5778 yes | no | yes | yes
5779 Arguments :
5780 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
5781 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
5782 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
5783 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
5784 ones.
5785
5786 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
5787 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5788 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5789
5790 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
5791 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
5792 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
5793 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, and as a trick, it is possible to pass it
5794 after "\r\n" following the version string.
5795
5796 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
5797 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
5798 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
5799 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
5800 the lack of any response.
5801
5802 The port and interval are specified in the server configuration.
5803
5804 This option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works with
5805 plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts bound
5806 to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon.
5807
5808 Examples :
5809 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
5810 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
5811 backend https_relay
5812 mode tcp
5813 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1\r\nHost:\ www
5814 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
5815
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09005816 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
5817 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
5818 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01005819
5820
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005821option httpclose
5822no option httpclose
5823 Enable or disable passive HTTP connection closing
5824 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5825 yes | yes | yes | yes
5826 Arguments : none
5827
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005828 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
5829 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
5830 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
5831 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005832 as "option http-server-close", "option forceclose", "option httpclose" or
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005833 "option http-tunnel".
5834
5835 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will work in HTTP tunnel mode and check
5836 if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction, and will
5837 add one if missing. Each end should react to this by actively closing the TCP
5838 connection after each transfer, thus resulting in a switch to the HTTP close
5839 mode. Any "Connection" header different from "close" will also be removed.
5840 Note that this option is deprecated since what it does is very cheap but not
5841 reliable. Using "option http-server-close" or "option forceclose" is strongly
5842 recommended instead.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005843
5844 It seldom happens that some servers incorrectly ignore this header and do not
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005845 close the connection even though they reply "Connection: close". For this
Willy Tarreau0dfdf192010-01-05 11:33:11 +01005846 reason, they are not compatible with older HTTP 1.0 browsers. If this happens
5847 it is possible to use the "option forceclose" which actively closes the
5848 request connection once the server responds. Option "forceclose" also
5849 releases the server connection earlier because it does not have to wait for
5850 the client to acknowledge it.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005851
5852 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
5853 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Cyril Bonté653dcd62014-02-20 00:13:15 +01005854 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close",
5855 "option forceclose", "option http-keep-alive" or "option http-tunnel". Please
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01005856 check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option combines with others when
5857 frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005858
5859 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5860 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5861
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +02005862 See also : "option forceclose", "option http-server-close" and
5863 "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005864
5865
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005866option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005867 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
5868 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5869 yes | yes | yes | yes
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005870 Arguments :
5871 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
5872 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
5873 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
5874 log analyser which only support the CLF format and which is not
5875 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005876
5877 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
5878 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
5879 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
5880 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
5881 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
5882 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
5883 ports.
5884
5885 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
5886
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01005887 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
5888 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02005889
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02005890 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
5891
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02005892 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01005893
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005894
5895option http_proxy
5896no option http_proxy
5897 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
5898 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5899 yes | yes | yes | yes
5900 Arguments : none
5901
5902 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
5903 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
5904 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
5905 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
5906 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
5907
5908 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
5909 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01005910 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
5911 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02005912
5913 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
5914 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
5915
5916 Example :
5917 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
5918 backend direct_forward
5919 option httpclose
5920 option http_proxy
5921
5922 See also : "option httpclose"
5923
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005924
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005925option independent-streams
5926no option independent-streams
5927 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005928 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5929 yes | yes | yes | yes
5930 Arguments : none
5931
5932 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
5933 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
5934 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
5935 receive data or not.
5936
5937 While this default behaviour is desirable for almost all applications, there
5938 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
5939 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
5940 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
5941 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
5942 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
5943 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
5944 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
5945 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
5946 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
5947 socket buffers.
5948
5949 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
5950 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
5951 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
5952 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
5953 slow lines, so use it with caution.
5954
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005955 Note: older versions used to call this setting "option independent-streams"
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005956 with a spelling mistake. This spelling is still supported but
5957 deprecated.
5958
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02005959 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02005960
5961
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02005962option ldap-check
5963 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
5964 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5965 yes | no | yes | yes
5966 Arguments : none
5967
5968 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
5969 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
5970 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
5971 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
5972
5973 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
5974 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
5975
5976 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
5977 configure it.
5978
5979 Example :
5980 option ldap-check
5981
5982 See also : "option httpchk"
5983
5984
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09005985option external-check
5986 Use external processes for server health checks
5987 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5988 yes | no | yes | yes
5989
5990 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
5991 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
5992 command".
5993
5994 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
5995
5996 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
5997
5998
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02005999option log-health-checks
6000no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006001 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006002 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6003 yes | no | yes | yes
6004 Arguments : none
6005
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006006 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
6007 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
6008 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006009
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006010 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
6011 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
6012 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
6013 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
6014 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
6015
6016 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (eg: enable/disable on
6017 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006018
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02006019 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
6020 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
6021 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02006022
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006023
6024option log-separate-errors
6025no option log-separate-errors
6026 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
6027 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6028 yes | yes | yes | no
6029 Arguments : none
6030
6031 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes haproxy
6032 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
6033 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
6034 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
6035 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
6036 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
6037 provides very important information.
6038
6039 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
6040 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
6041 error logs.
6042
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006043 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02006044 logging.
6045
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006046
6047option logasap
6048no option logasap
6049 Enable or disable early logging of HTTP requests
6050 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6051 yes | yes | yes | no
6052 Arguments : none
6053
6054 By default, HTTP requests are logged upon termination so that the total
6055 transfer time and the number of bytes appear in the logs. When large objects
6056 are being transferred, it may take a while before the request appears in the
6057 logs. Using "option logasap", the request gets logged as soon as the server
6058 sends the complete headers. The only missing information in the logs will be
6059 the total number of bytes which will indicate everything except the amount
6060 of data transferred, and the total time which will not take the transfer
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01006061 time into account. In such a situation, it's a good practice to capture the
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006062 "Content-Length" response header so that the logs at least indicate how many
6063 bytes are expected to be transferred.
6064
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01006065 Examples :
6066 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
6067 mode http
6068 option httplog
6069 option logasap
6070 log 192.168.2.200 local3
6071
6072 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
6073 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
6074 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
6075 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
6076
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006077 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01006078 logging.
6079
6080
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006081option mysql-check [ user <username> [ post-41 ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006082 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006083 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6084 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006085 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02006086 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
6087 server.
Nenad Merdanovic6639a7c2014-05-30 14:26:32 +02006088 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02006089
6090 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
6091 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
6092 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialisation packet and/or
6093 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
6094 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires adding an authorization
6095 in the MySQL table, like this :
6096
6097 USE mysql;
6098 INSERT INTO user (Host,User) values ('<ip_of_haproxy>','<username>');
6099 FLUSH PRIVILEGES;
6100
6101 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
6102 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialisation packet or
6103 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
6104 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
6105 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
6106 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
6107 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
6108 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
6109 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
6110
6111 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
6112 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006113
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02006114 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006115
6116 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
6117 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
6118 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6119 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006120 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
6121 server to route the client via the machine hosting haproxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01006122
6123 See also: "option httpchk"
6124
6125
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006126option nolinger
6127no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006128 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006129 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6130 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006131 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006132
6133 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (eg: they are
6134 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
6135 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
6136 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
6137 connections.
6138
6139 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
6140 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
6141 the session is instantly purged from the system's tables. This usually has
6142 side effects such as increased number of TCP resets due to old retransmits
6143 getting immediately rejected. Some firewalls may sometimes complain about
6144 this too.
6145
6146 For this reason, it is not recommended to use this option when not absolutely
6147 needed. You know that you need it when you have thousands of FIN_WAIT1
6148 sessions on your system (TIME_WAIT ones do not count).
6149
6150 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
6151 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
6152 for servers.
6153
6154 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6155 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6156
6157
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006158option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
6159 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
6160 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6161 yes | yes | yes | yes
6162 Arguments :
6163 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
6164 matching <network>
6165 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
6166 header name.
6167
6168 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
6169 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
6170 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
6171 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
6172 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
6173 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
6174 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
6175 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
6176 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
6177 possible that the client has already brought one.
6178
6179 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
6180 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
6181 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
6182 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
6183 header and requires different one.
6184
6185 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
6186 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
6187 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
6188 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
6189 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
6190 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
6191 private networks or 127.0.0.1.
6192
6193 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
6194 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
6195 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
6196 both are defined.
6197
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006198 Examples :
6199 # Original Destination address
6200 frontend www
6201 mode http
6202 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
6203
6204 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
6205 backend www
6206 mode http
6207 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
6208
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02006209 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
6210 "option forceclose"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02006211
6212
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006213option persist
6214no option persist
6215 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
6216 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6217 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006218 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006219
6220 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
6221 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
6222 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
6223 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
6224 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
6225 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
6226 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
6227 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
6228 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
6229 redirected to another valid server.
6230
6231 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6232 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6233
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006234 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006235
6236
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01006237option pgsql-check [ user <username> ]
6238 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
6239 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6240 yes | no | yes | yes
6241 Arguments :
6242 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
6243 PostgreSQL server.
6244
6245 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
6246 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
6247 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
6248 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
6249
6250 See also: "option httpchk"
6251
6252
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006253option prefer-last-server
6254no option prefer-last-server
6255 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
6256 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6257 yes | no | yes | yes
6258 Arguments : none
6259
6260 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
6261 request was sent to a server to which haproxy still holds a connection, it is
6262 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
6263 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
6264 we only indicate a preference which haproxy tries to apply without any form
6265 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
6266 this option is used, haproxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
6267 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
6268 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01006269 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
6270 haproxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
6271 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required). This is mandatory for
6272 use with the broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
6273 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
6274 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
6275 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01006276
6277 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6278 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6279
6280 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
6281
6282
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006283option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006284option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006285no option redispatch
6286 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
6287 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6288 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006289 Arguments :
6290 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
6291 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
6292 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
6293 N indicate a redispath is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
6294 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
6295 historical behaviour of redispatching on the last retry, a
6296 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
6297 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
6298 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
6299
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006300
6301 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
6302 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
6303 be able to access the service anymore.
6304
6305 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their
6306 persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
6307
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07006308 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006309 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
6310 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006311
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006312 This form is the preferred form, which replaces both the "redispatch" and
6313 "redisp" keywords.
6314
6315 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6316 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6317
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01006318 See also : "redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006319
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006320
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006321option redis-check
6322 Use redis health checks for server testing
6323 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6324 yes | no | yes | yes
6325 Arguments : none
6326
6327 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
6328 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6329 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
6330 find the "+PONG" response message.
6331
6332 Example :
6333 option redis-check
6334
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03006335 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02006336
6337
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006338option smtpchk
6339option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
6340 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
6341 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6342 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01006343 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006344 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
6345 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESTMP). All other
6346 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
6347
6348 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
6349 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
6350 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
6351
6352 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
6353 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
6354 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
6355 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
6356 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
6357 dead server.
6358
6359 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
6360 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
6361 so you may want to experiment to improve the behaviour. Using telnet on port
6362 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
6363
6364 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
6365 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
6366 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
6367 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02006368 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006369
6370 Example :
6371 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
6372
6373 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
6374
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01006375
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02006376option socket-stats
6377no option socket-stats
6378
6379 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
6380 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6381 yes | yes | yes | no
6382
6383 Arguments : none
6384
6385
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006386option splice-auto
6387no option splice-auto
6388 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
6389 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6390 yes | yes | yes | yes
6391 Arguments : none
6392
6393 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
6394 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
6395 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. Haproxy
6396 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006397 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006398 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
6399 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
6400 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
6401 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6402
6403 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
6404 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
6405 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
6406 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
6407 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
6408 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
6409 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
6410 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
6411 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
6412 keyword.
6413
6414 Example :
6415 option splice-auto
6416
6417 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6418 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6419
6420 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
6421 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6422
6423
6424option splice-request
6425no option splice-request
6426 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
6427 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6428 yes | yes | yes | yes
6429 Arguments : none
6430
6431 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006432 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006433 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6434 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6435 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6436 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6437
6438 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6439
6440 Example :
6441 option splice-request
6442
6443 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6444 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6445
6446 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
6447 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6448
6449
6450option splice-response
6451no option splice-response
6452 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
6453 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6454 yes | yes | yes | yes
6455 Arguments : none
6456
6457 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, haproxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04006458 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01006459 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
6460 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
6461 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
6462 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
6463
6464 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
6465
6466 Example :
6467 option splice-response
6468
6469 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6470 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6471
6472 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
6473 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
6474
6475
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01006476option spop-check
6477 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
6478 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6479 no | no | no | yes
6480 Arguments : none
6481
6482 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
6483 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
6484 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
6485 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
6486
6487 Example :
6488 option spop-check
6489
6490 See also : "option httpchk"
6491
6492
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006493option srvtcpka
6494no option srvtcpka
6495 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
6496 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6497 yes | no | yes | yes
6498 Arguments : none
6499
6500 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6501 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6502 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6503 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6504
6505 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6506 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6507 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6508 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6509
6510 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6511 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6512 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6513 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6514 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6515
6516 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6517
6518 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
6519 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
6520 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
6521
6522 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6523 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6524
6525 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
6526
6527
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006528option ssl-hello-chk
6529 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
6530 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6531 yes | no | yes | yes
6532 Arguments : none
6533
6534 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
6535 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
6536 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
6537 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
6538 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
6539 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
6540 hello message.
6541
6542 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
6543 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
6544 messages, which is appreciable.
6545
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006546 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into haproxy
6547 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
6548 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006549
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02006550 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
6551
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01006552
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006553option tcp-check
6554 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
6555 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6556 yes | no | yes | yes
6557
6558 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
6559 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
6560
6561 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
6562 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
6563 attempt, which remains the default mode.
6564
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006565 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006566 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
6567 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
6568 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
6569 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
6570 only.
6571
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006572 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006573 The connection is opened and haproxy waits for the server to present some
6574 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
6575 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
6576 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
6577
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006578 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006579 used to test a hello-type protocol. Haproxy sends a message, the server
6580 responds and its response is analysed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006581 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006582 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
6583 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
6584 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
6585 the respective protocols.
6586 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
6587 analysed.
6588
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006589 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the
6590 script.
6591
6592 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
6593 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr
6594 in debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting.
6595 The "comment" is of course optional.
6596
6597
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006598 Examples :
6599 # perform a POP check (analyse only server's banner)
6600 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006601 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006602
6603 # perform an IMAP check (analyse only server's banner)
6604 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006605 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006606
6607 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
6608 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006609 # (send a command then analyse the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006610 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006611 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006612 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02006613 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006614 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006615 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
6616 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006617 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006618 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
6619 tcp-check expect string +OK
6620
6621 forge a HTTP request, then analyse the response
6622 (send many headers before analyzing)
6623 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006624 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006625 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
6626 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
6627 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
6628 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02006629 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01006630
6631
6632 See also : "tcp-check expect", "tcp-check send"
6633
6634
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006635option tcp-smart-accept
6636no option tcp-smart-accept
6637 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
6638 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6639 yes | yes | yes | no
6640 Arguments : none
6641
6642 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
6643 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
6644 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
6645 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
6646 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
6647 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
6648
6649 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
6650 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
6651 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
6652 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
6653
6654 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
6655 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
6656 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
6657 fall back to normal behaviour by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
6658
6659 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
6660 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
6661 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
6662
6663 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
6664 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
6665 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
6666
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02006667 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
6668
6669
6670option tcp-smart-connect
6671no option tcp-smart-connect
6672 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
6673 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6674 yes | no | yes | yes
6675 Arguments : none
6676
6677 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
6678 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
6679 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
6680 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
6681 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
6682
6683 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
6684 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
6685 complex.
6686
6687 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
6688 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
6689 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
6690
6691 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
6692 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
6693
6694 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
6695
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02006696
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006697option tcpka
6698 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
6699 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6700 yes | yes | yes | yes
6701 Arguments : none
6702
6703 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
6704 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
6705 periods (eg: remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
6706 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
6707
6708 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
6709 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
6710 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
6711 operating system and its tuning parameters.
6712
6713 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
6714 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
6715 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
6716 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
6717 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
6718
6719 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
6720
6721 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
6722 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
6723 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
6724 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
6725 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
6726 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
6727 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
6728 backends.
6729
6730 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
6731
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006732
6733option tcplog
6734 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
6735 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6736 yes | yes | yes | yes
6737 Arguments : none
6738
6739 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
6740 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
6741 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
6742 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
6743 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
6744 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
6745 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
6746 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
6747
6748 This option may be set either in the frontend or the backend.
6749
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02006750 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
6751
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02006752 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006753
6754
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006755option transparent
6756no option transparent
6757 Enable client-side transparent proxying
6758 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01006759 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006760 Arguments : none
6761
6762 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
6763 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
6764 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
6765 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
6766 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
6767 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
6768 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
6769 appropriate server.
6770
6771 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
6772 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
6773
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01006774 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01006775 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01006776
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01006777
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006778external-check command <command>
6779 Executable to run when performing an external-check
6780 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6781 yes | no | yes | yes
6782
6783 Arguments :
6784 <command> is the external command to run
6785
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006786 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
6787
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006788 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006789
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01006790 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
6791 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
6792 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
6793 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
6794 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
6795 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006796
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01006797 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
6798
6799 Environment variables :
6800 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
6801 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
6802
6803 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
6804
6805 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
6806
6807 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
6808 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
6809 for a UNIX socket).
6810
6811 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
6812
6813 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
6814
6815 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
6816
6817 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
6818
6819 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
6820
6821 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
6822 socket).
6823
6824 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
6825 the command may be set using "external-check path".
6826
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09006827 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
6828 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
6829 failed.
6830
6831 Example :
6832 external-check command /bin/true
6833
6834 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
6835
6836
6837external-check path <path>
6838 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
6839 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6840 yes | no | yes | yes
6841
6842 Arguments :
6843 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
6844
6845 The default path is "".
6846
6847 Example :
6848 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
6849
6850 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
6851 "external-check command"
6852
6853
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006854persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02006855persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006856 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
6857 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6858 yes | no | yes | yes
6859 Arguments :
6860 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006861 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
6862 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006863
6864 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
6865 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
6866 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analysed
6867 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
6868 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
6869 forwarded to this server.
6870
6871 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
6872 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
6873 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01006874 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006875 a single "listen" section.
6876
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02006877 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
6878 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
6879 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
6880
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006881 Example :
6882 listen tse-farm
6883 bind :3389
6884 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
6885 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
6886 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
6887 # apply RDP cookie persistence
6888 persist rdp-cookie
6889 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02006890 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006891 balance rdp-cookie
6892 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
6893 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
6894
Simon Hormanab814e02011-06-24 14:50:20 +09006895 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request", the "req_rdp_cookie" ACL and
6896 the rdp_cookie pattern fetch function.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02006897
6898
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006899rate-limit sessions <rate>
6900 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
6901 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6902 yes | yes | yes | no
6903 Arguments :
6904 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
6905 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
6906
6907 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
6908 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
6909 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
6910 (in system buffers) and haproxy will not even be aware that sessions are
6911 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
6912 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
6913
6914 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
6915 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
6916 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
6917 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
6918
6919 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
6920 listen smtp
6921 mode tcp
6922 bind :25
6923 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +02006924 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006925
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +02006926 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
6927 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
6928 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +01006929
6930 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
6931
6932
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006933redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6934redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
6935redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006936 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
6937 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
6938 no | yes | yes | yes
6939
6940 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +01006941 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02006942
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006943 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006944 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006945 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
6946 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
6947 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006948
6949 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
6950 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
6951 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
6952 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
6953 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006954 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
6955 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
6956 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
6957 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006958
6959 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
6960 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
6961 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
6962 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
6963 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
6964 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03006965 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02006966 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01006967 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
6968 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
6969 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006970
6971 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006972 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
6973 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
6974 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +02006975 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +01006976 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
6977 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
6978 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
6979 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006980
6981 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
6982 expected behaviour of a redirection :
6983
6984 - "drop-query"
6985 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
6986 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
6987 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
6988 with a location-type redirect.
6989
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01006990 - "append-slash"
6991 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
6992 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
6993 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
6994 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
6995
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01006996 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
6997 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
6998 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
6999 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
7000 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
7001 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
7002 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
7003
7004 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
7005 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
7006 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
7007 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
7008 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
7009 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
7010 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007011
7012 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
7013 acl clear dst_port 80
7014 acl secure dst_port 8080
7015 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007016 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007017 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007018 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
7019
7020 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +01007021 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
7022 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
7023 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +01007024 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007025
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +01007026 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
7027 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
7028 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
7029
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007030 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by haproxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +01007031 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +02007032
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007033 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +02007034 http-request redirect code 301 location \
7035 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
7036 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +01007037
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007038 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +02007039
7040
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007041redisp (deprecated)
7042redispatch (deprecated)
7043 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
7044 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7045 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007046 Arguments : none
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007047
7048 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
7049 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
7050 be able to access the service anymore.
7051
7052 Specifying "redispatch" will allow the proxy to break their persistence and
7053 redistribute them to a working server.
7054
7055 It also allows to retry last connection to another server in case of multiple
7056 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
7057 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007058
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007059 This form is deprecated, do not use it in any new configuration, use the new
7060 "option redispatch" instead.
7061
7062 See also : "option redispatch"
7063
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007064
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007065reqadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007066 Add a header at the end of the HTTP request
7067 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7068 no | yes | yes | yes
7069 Arguments :
7070 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7071 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007072 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007073
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007074 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7075 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7076
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007077 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7078 the last header of an HTTP request.
7079
7080 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7081 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7082 responses.
7083
Willy Tarreau8abd4cd2010-01-31 14:30:44 +01007084 Example : add "X-Proto: SSL" to requests coming via port 81
7085 acl is-ssl dst_port 81
7086 reqadd X-Proto:\ SSL if is-ssl
7087
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007088 See also: "rspadd", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header manipulation,
7089 and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007090
7091
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007092reqallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7093reqiallow <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007094 Definitely allow an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7095 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7096 no | yes | yes | yes
7097 Arguments :
7098 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7099 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7100 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7101 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7102 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7103 "reqallow" keyword strictly matches case while "reqiallow"
7104 ignores case.
7105
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007106 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7107 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7108
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007109 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7110 <search> will mark the request as allowed, even if any later test would
7111 result in a deny. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7112 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007113 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007114
7115 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7116 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7117
7118 Example :
7119 # allow www.* but refuse *.local
7120 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7121 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7122
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007123 See also: "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about HTTP header
7124 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007125
7126
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007127reqdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7128reqidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007129 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP request
7130 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7131 no | yes | yes | yes
7132 Arguments :
7133 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7134 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7135 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7136 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7137 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqdel"
7138 keyword strictly matches case while "reqidel" ignores case.
7139
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007140 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7141 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7142
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007143 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request
7144 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
7145 and/or dangerous headers or cookies from a request before passing it to the
7146 next servers.
7147
7148 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7149 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7150 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7151
7152 Example :
7153 # remove X-Forwarded-For header and SERVER cookie
7154 reqidel ^X-Forwarded-For:.*
7155 reqidel ^Cookie:.*SERVER=
7156
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007157 See also: "reqadd", "reqrep", "rspdel", "http-request", section 6 about
7158 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007159
7160
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007161reqdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7162reqideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007163 Deny an HTTP request if a line matches a regular expression
7164 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7165 no | yes | yes | yes
7166 Arguments :
7167 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7168 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7169 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7170 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7171 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7172 "reqdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "reqideny" ignores
7173 case.
7174
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007175 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7176 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7177
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007178 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7179 <search> will mark the request as denied, even if any later test would
7180 result in an allow. The test applies both to the request line and to request
7181 headers. Keep in mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007182 header names are not.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007183
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007184 A denied request will generate an "HTTP 403 forbidden" response once the
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007185 complete request has been parsed. This is consistent with what is practiced
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007186 using ACLs.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007187
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007188 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7189 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7190
7191 Example :
7192 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*
7193 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7194 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7195
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007196 See also: "reqallow", "rspdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7197 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007198
7199
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007200reqpass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7201reqipass <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007202 Ignore any HTTP request line matching a regular expression in next rules
7203 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7204 no | yes | yes | yes
7205 Arguments :
7206 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7207 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7208 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7209 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7210 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7211 "reqpass" keyword strictly matches case while "reqipass" ignores
7212 case.
7213
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007214 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7215 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7216
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007217 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7218 <search> will skip next rules, without assigning any deny or allow verdict.
7219 The test applies both to the request line and to request headers. Keep in
7220 mind that URLs in request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7221
7222 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7223 Reqdeny, reqallow and reqpass should be avoided in new designs.
7224
7225 Example :
7226 # refuse *.local, then allow www.*, but ignore "www.private.local"
7227 reqipass ^Host:\ www.private\.local
7228 reqideny ^Host:\ .*\.local
7229 reqiallow ^Host:\ www\.
7230
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007231 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "block", "http-request", section 6 about
7232 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007233
7234
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007235reqrep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7236reqirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007237 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP request line
7238 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7239 no | yes | yes | yes
7240 Arguments :
7241 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7242 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7243 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7244 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7245 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The "reqrep"
7246 keyword strictly matches case while "reqirep" ignores case.
7247
7248 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7249 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7250 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7251 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007252 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007253
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007254 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7255 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7256
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007257 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the request (both
7258 the request line and header lines) will be completely replaced with <string>.
7259 Most common use of this is to rewrite URLs or domain names in "Host" headers.
7260
7261 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7262 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7263 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7264 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that URLs in
7265 request line are case-sensitive while header names are not.
7266
7267 Example :
7268 # replace "/static/" with "/" at the beginning of any request path.
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04007269 reqrep ^([^\ :]*)\ /static/(.*) \1\ /\2
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007270 # replace "www.mydomain.com" with "www" in the host name.
7271 reqirep ^Host:\ www.mydomain.com Host:\ www
7272
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007273 See also: "reqadd", "reqdel", "rsprep", "tune.bufsize", "http-request",
7274 section 6 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007275
7276
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007277reqtarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7278reqitarpit <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007279 Tarpit an HTTP request containing a line matching a regular expression
7280 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7281 no | yes | yes | yes
7282 Arguments :
7283 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7284 request line. This is an extended regular expression. Parenthesis
7285 grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash is required.
7286 Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using a backslash
7287 ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time. The
7288 "reqtarpit" keyword strictly matches case while "reqitarpit"
7289 ignores case.
7290
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007291 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7292 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7293
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007294 A request containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7295 <search> will be tarpitted, which means that it will connect to nowhere, will
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007296 be kept open for a pre-defined time, then will return an HTTP error 500 so
7297 that the attacker does not suspect it has been tarpitted. The status 500 will
7298 be reported in the logs, but the completion flags will indicate "PT". The
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007299 delay is defined by "timeout tarpit", or "timeout connect" if the former is
7300 not set.
7301
7302 The goal of the tarpit is to slow down robots attacking servers with
7303 identifiable requests. Many robots limit their outgoing number of connections
7304 and stay connected waiting for a reply which can take several minutes to
7305 come. Depending on the environment and attack, it may be particularly
7306 efficient at reducing the load on the network and firewalls.
7307
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007308 Examples :
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007309 # ignore user-agents reporting any flavour of "Mozilla" or "MSIE", but
7310 # block all others.
7311 reqipass ^User-Agent:\.*(Mozilla|MSIE)
7312 reqitarpit ^User-Agent:
7313
Willy Tarreau5321c422010-01-28 20:35:13 +01007314 # block bad guys
7315 acl badguys src 10.1.0.3 172.16.13.20/28
7316 reqitarpit . if badguys
7317
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007318 See also: "reqallow", "reqdeny", "reqpass", "http-request", section 6
7319 about HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007320
7321
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007322retries <value>
7323 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
7324 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7325 yes | no | yes | yes
7326 Arguments :
7327 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
7328 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
7329 default value is 3.
7330
7331 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
7332 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
7333 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
7334
7335 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07007336 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
7337 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +02007338
7339 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
7340 server even if a cookie references a different server.
7341
7342 See also : "option redispatch"
7343
7344
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007345rspadd <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007346 Add a header at the end of the HTTP response
7347 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7348 no | yes | yes | yes
7349 Arguments :
7350 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7351 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007352 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007353
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007354 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7355 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7356
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007357 A new line consisting in <string> followed by a line feed will be added after
7358 the last header of an HTTP response.
7359
7360 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7361 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7362 responses.
7363
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007364 See also: "rspdel" "reqadd", "http-response", section 6 about HTTP header
7365 manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007366
7367
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007368rspdel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7369rspidel <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007370 Delete all headers matching a regular expression in an HTTP response
7371 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7372 no | yes | yes | yes
7373 Arguments :
7374 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7375 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7376 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7377 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7378 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7379 The "rspdel" keyword strictly matches case while "rspidel"
7380 ignores case.
7381
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007382 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7383 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7384
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007385 Any header line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response
7386 will be completely deleted. Most common use of this is to remove unwanted
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007387 and/or sensitive headers or cookies from a response before passing it to the
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007388 client.
7389
7390 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7391 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7392 responses. Keep in mind that header names are not case-sensitive.
7393
7394 Example :
7395 # remove the Server header from responses
Willy Tarreau5e80e022013-05-25 08:31:25 +02007396 rspidel ^Server:.*
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007397
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007398 See also: "rspadd", "rsprep", "reqdel", "http-response", section 6 about
7399 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007400
7401
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007402rspdeny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7403rspideny <search> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007404 Block an HTTP response if a line matches a regular expression
7405 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7406 no | yes | yes | yes
7407 Arguments :
7408 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7409 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7410 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7411 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7412 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7413 The "rspdeny" keyword strictly matches case while "rspideny"
7414 ignores case.
7415
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007416 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7417 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7418
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007419 A response containing any line which matches extended regular expression
7420 <search> will mark the request as denied. The test applies both to the
7421 response line and to response headers. Keep in mind that header names are not
7422 case-sensitive.
7423
7424 Main use of this keyword is to prevent sensitive information leak and to
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +01007425 block the response before it reaches the client. If a response is denied, it
7426 will be replaced with an HTTP 502 error so that the client never retrieves
7427 any sensitive data.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007428
7429 It is easier, faster and more powerful to use ACLs to write access policies.
7430 Rspdeny should be avoided in new designs.
7431
7432 Example :
7433 # Ensure that no content type matching ms-word will leak
7434 rspideny ^Content-type:\.*/ms-word
7435
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007436 See also: "reqdeny", "acl", "block", "http-response", section 6 about
7437 HTTP header manipulation and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007438
7439
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007440rsprep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>]
7441rspirep <search> <string> [{if | unless} <cond>] (ignore case)
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007442 Replace a regular expression with a string in an HTTP response line
7443 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7444 no | yes | yes | yes
7445 Arguments :
7446 <search> is the regular expression applied to HTTP headers and to the
7447 response line. This is an extended regular expression, so
7448 parenthesis grouping is supported and no preliminary backslash
7449 is required. Any space or known delimiter must be escaped using
7450 a backslash ('\'). The pattern applies to a full line at a time.
7451 The "rsprep" keyword strictly matches case while "rspirep"
7452 ignores case.
7453
7454 <string> is the complete line to be added. Any space or known delimiter
7455 must be escaped using a backslash ('\'). References to matched
7456 pattern groups are possible using the common \N form, with N
7457 being a single digit between 0 and 9. Please refer to section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007458 6 about HTTP header manipulation for more information.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007459
Willy Tarreaufdb563c2010-01-31 15:43:27 +01007460 <cond> is an optional matching condition built from ACLs. It makes it
7461 possible to ignore this rule when other conditions are not met.
7462
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007463 Any line matching extended regular expression <search> in the response (both
7464 the response line and header lines) will be completely replaced with
7465 <string>. Most common use of this is to rewrite Location headers.
7466
7467 Header transformations only apply to traffic which passes through HAProxy,
7468 and not to traffic generated by HAProxy, such as health-checks or error
7469 responses. Note that for increased readability, it is suggested to add enough
7470 spaces between the request and the response. Keep in mind that header names
7471 are not case-sensitive.
7472
7473 Example :
7474 # replace "Location: 127.0.0.1:8080" with "Location: www.mydomain.com"
7475 rspirep ^Location:\ 127.0.0.1:8080 Location:\ www.mydomain.com
7476
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007477 See also: "rspadd", "rspdel", "reqrep", "http-response", section 6 about
7478 HTTP header manipulation, and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +01007479
7480
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007481server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007482 Declare a server in a backend
7483 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7484 no | no | yes | yes
7485 Arguments :
7486 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Cyril Bonté941a0c62012-10-15 19:44:24 +02007487 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007488 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007489
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +01007490 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
7491 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
7492 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
7493 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +02007494 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
7495 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
7496 intercepted and haproxy must forward to the original destination
7497 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
7498 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007499 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
7500 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
7501 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
7502 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
7503 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7504 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7505 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007506 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007507 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7508 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +01007509 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
7510 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007511
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02007512 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007513 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
7514 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
7515 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
7516 adding this value to the client's port.
7517
7518 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
7519 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007520 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007521
7522 Examples :
7523 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
7524 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007525 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007526 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
7527 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
7528 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007529
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02007530 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
7531 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
7532 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
7533 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
7534 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
7535
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007536 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
7537 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007538
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007539server-state-file-name [<file>]
7540 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
7541 this backend. It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file"
7542 is set to "local". When <file> is not provided or if this directive is not
7543 set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a slash '/', then it is
7544 considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is concatenated to the
7545 global directive "server-state-file-base".
7546
7547 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
7548 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
7549
7550 global
7551 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
7552
7553 backend bk
7554 load-server-state-from-file
7555
7556 See also: "server-state-file-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
7557 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007558
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02007559server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
7560 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
7561 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
7562 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7563 no | no | yes | yes
7564
7565 Arguments:
7566 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
7567
7568 <num | range>
7569 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
7570 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
7571 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
7572 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
7573
7574 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
7575
7576 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
7577
7578 <params*>
7579 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
7580 keyword.
7581
7582 Examples:
7583 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
7584 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
7585 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
7586
7587 # or
7588 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
7589
7590 # would be equivalent to:
7591 server srv1 google.com:80 check
7592 server srv2 google.com:80 check
7593 server srv3 google.com:80 check
7594
7595
7596
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007597source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007598source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007599source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007600 Set the source address for outgoing connections
7601 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7602 yes | no | yes | yes
7603 Arguments :
7604 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
7605 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007606
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007607 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01007608 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
7609 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
7610 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
7611 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
7612 supported prefixes are :
7613 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
7614 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
7615 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +02007616 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02007617 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7618 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007619
7620 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
7621 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +02007622 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
7623 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
7624 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007625
7626 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
7627 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
7628 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
7629 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
7630 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
7631 <addr>.
7632
7633 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
7634 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
7635 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
7636 port.
7637
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007638 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
7639 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
7640 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
7641 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +01007642 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007643 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
7644 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
7645 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
7646 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
7647 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
7648 HTTP header.
7649
7650 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
7651 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04007652 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007653 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
7654 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
7655 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
7656 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
7657 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
7658 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
7659 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
7660
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +01007661 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
7662 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
7663 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
7664 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
7665 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
7666 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
7667
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007668 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
7669 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
7670 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
7671 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
7672
7673 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
7674 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
7675 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
7676 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
7677 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
7678 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
7679
7680 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
7681 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
7682 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
7683 there are two methods :
7684
7685 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
7686 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
7687 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
7688 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
7689 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
7690 of the client ranges may be used.
7691
7692 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
7693 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
7694 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
7695 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
7696 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
7697 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
7698 same session.
7699
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007700 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
7701 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
7702 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007703 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007704
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +02007705 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
7706
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007707 Examples :
7708 backend private
7709 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
7710 source 192.168.1.200
7711
7712 backend transparent_ssl1
7713 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
7714 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7715
7716 backend transparent_ssl2
7717 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
7718 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
7719 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
7720
7721 backend transparent_ssl3
7722 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
7723 # is more conntrack-friendly.
7724 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
7725
7726 backend transparent_smtp
7727 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
7728 # with Tproxy version 4.
7729 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
7730
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +02007731 backend transparent_http
7732 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
7733 # proxy.
7734 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
7735
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02007736 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007737 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
7738
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01007739
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007740srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
7741 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
7742 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7743 yes | no | yes | yes
7744 Arguments :
7745 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
7746 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
7747 as explained at the top of this document.
7748
7749 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
7750 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
7751 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
7752 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
7753 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
7754 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
7755 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
7756
7757 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
7758 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
7759 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
7760 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
7761 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01007762 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007763 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01007764 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007765
7766 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
7767 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
7768 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
7769 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
7770 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
7771 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
7772
7773 This parameter is provided for compatibility but is currently deprecated.
7774 Please use "timeout server" instead.
7775
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02007776 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout client" and
7777 "clitimeout".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01007778
7779
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007780stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
7781 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
7782 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007783 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007784
7785 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
7786 matched.
7787
7788 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
7789 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
7790
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007791 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
7792 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
7793 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
7794
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +01007795 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
7796 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
7797 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
7798 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007799
7800 Example :
7801 # statistics admin level only for localhost
7802 backend stats_localhost
7803 stats enable
7804 stats admin if LOCALHOST
7805
7806 Example :
7807 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
7808 backend stats_auth
7809 stats enable
7810 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
7811 stats admin if TRUE
7812
7813 Example :
7814 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
7815 userlist stats-auth
7816 group admin users admin
7817 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
7818 group readonly users haproxy
7819 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
7820
7821 backend stats_auth
7822 stats enable
7823 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
7824 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
7825 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
7826 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
7827
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01007828 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
7829 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7830 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +02007831
7832
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007833stats auth <user>:<passwd>
7834 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
7835 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007836 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007837 Arguments :
7838 <user> is a user name to grant access to
7839
7840 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
7841
7842 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
7843 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
7844 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
7845 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
7846 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
7847 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
7848
7849 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
7850 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
7851 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02007852 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007853
7854 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
7855 report using "stats scope".
7856
7857 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7858 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7859 unobvious parameters.
7860
7861 Example :
7862 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7863 backend public_www
7864 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7865 stats enable
7866 stats hide-version
7867 stats scope .
7868 stats uri /admin?stats
7869 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7870 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7871 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7872
7873 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7874 backend private_monitoring
7875 stats enable
7876 stats uri /admin?stats
7877 stats refresh 5s
7878
7879 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
7880
7881
7882stats enable
7883 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
7884 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007885 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007886 Arguments : none
7887
7888 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
7889 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
7890 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
7891 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
7892 - stats auth : no authentication
7893 - stats scope : no restriction
7894
7895 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7896 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7897 unobvious parameters.
7898
7899 Example :
7900 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7901 backend public_www
7902 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
7903 stats enable
7904 stats hide-version
7905 stats scope .
7906 stats uri /admin?stats
7907 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7908 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7909 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
7910
7911 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7912 backend private_monitoring
7913 stats enable
7914 stats uri /admin?stats
7915 stats refresh 5s
7916
7917 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
7918
7919
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007920stats hide-version
7921 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007922 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007923 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007924 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007925
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007926 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
7927 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
7928 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
7929 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
7930 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
7931 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007932
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007933 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7934 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7935 unobvious parameters.
7936
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007937 Example :
7938 # public access (limited to this backend only)
7939 backend public_www
7940 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02007941 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007942 stats hide-version
7943 stats scope .
7944 stats uri /admin?stats
7945 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
7946 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
7947 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007948
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007949 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
7950 backend private_monitoring
7951 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007952 stats uri /admin?stats
7953 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +01007954
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01007955 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +02007956
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01007957
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +02007958stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
7959 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7960 Access control for statistics
7961
7962 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7963 no | no | yes | yes
7964
7965 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
7966 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
7967 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
7968 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
7969 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
7970 should be asked to enter a username and password.
7971
7972 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
7973 instance.
7974
7975 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
7976 about ACL usage.
7977
7978
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007979stats realm <realm>
7980 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
7981 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02007982 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01007983 Arguments :
7984 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
7985 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
7986 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
7987
7988 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
7989 using a backslash ('\').
7990
7991 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
7992 only related to authentication.
7993
7994 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
7995 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
7996 unobvious parameters.
7997
7998 Example :
7999 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8000 backend public_www
8001 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8002 stats enable
8003 stats hide-version
8004 stats scope .
8005 stats uri /admin?stats
8006 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8007 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8008 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8009
8010 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8011 backend private_monitoring
8012 stats enable
8013 stats uri /admin?stats
8014 stats refresh 5s
8015
8016 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
8017
8018
8019stats refresh <delay>
8020 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
8021 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008022 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008023 Arguments :
8024 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
8025 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
8026 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
8027 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
8028 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
8029 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
8030
8031 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
8032 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
8033 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
8034 he wants automatic refresh of the page or not.
8035
8036 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8037 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8038 unobvious parameters.
8039
8040 Example :
8041 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8042 backend public_www
8043 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8044 stats enable
8045 stats hide-version
8046 stats scope .
8047 stats uri /admin?stats
8048 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8049 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8050 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8051
8052 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8053 backend private_monitoring
8054 stats enable
8055 stats uri /admin?stats
8056 stats refresh 5s
8057
8058 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8059
8060
8061stats scope { <name> | "." }
8062 Enable statistics and limit access scope
8063 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008064 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008065 Arguments :
8066 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
8067 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
8068 section in which the statement appears.
8069
8070 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
8071 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
8072 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
8073 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
8074 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
8075 exists.
8076
8077 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8078 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8079 unobvious parameters.
8080
8081 Example :
8082 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8083 backend public_www
8084 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8085 stats enable
8086 stats hide-version
8087 stats scope .
8088 stats uri /admin?stats
8089 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8090 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8091 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8092
8093 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8094 backend private_monitoring
8095 stats enable
8096 stats uri /admin?stats
8097 stats refresh 5s
8098
8099 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
8100
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008101
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008102stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008103 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
8104 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008105 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008106
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008107 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008108 description from global section is automatically used instead.
8109
8110 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8111 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
8112
8113 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8114 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008115 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008116
8117 Example :
8118 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8119 backend private_monitoring
8120 stats enable
8121 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
8122 stats uri /admin?stats
8123 stats refresh 5s
8124
8125 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
8126 global section.
8127
8128
8129stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008130 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
8131 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8132 yes | yes | yes | yes
8133 Arguments : none
8134
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03008135 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008136 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
8137 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
8138 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
8139 - IP (socket, server)
8140 - cookie (backend, server)
8141
8142 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8143 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008144 unobvious parameters. Default behaviour is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008145
8146 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
8147
8148
8149stats show-node [ <name> ]
8150 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
8151 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008152 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008153 Arguments:
8154 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
8155 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
8156
8157 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
8158 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Dmitry Sivachenko7823de32012-05-16 14:00:26 +04008159 provided for each customer. Default behaviour is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008160
8161 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8162 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8163 unobvious parameters.
8164
8165 Example:
8166 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8167 backend private_monitoring
8168 stats enable
8169 stats show-node Europe-1
8170 stats uri /admin?stats
8171 stats refresh 5s
8172
8173 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
8174 section.
8175
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008176
8177stats uri <prefix>
8178 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
8179 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +02008180 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008181 Arguments :
8182 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
8183 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
8184 query string.
8185
8186 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
8187 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
8188 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
8189 possible to reach it in the application.
8190
8191 The default URI compiled in haproxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008192 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008193 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
8194 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
8195 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
8196 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
8197
8198 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
8199 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
8200 an address or a port to statistics only.
8201
8202 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
8203 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
8204 unobvious parameters.
8205
8206 Example :
8207 # public access (limited to this backend only)
8208 backend public_www
8209 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
8210 stats enable
8211 stats hide-version
8212 stats scope .
8213 stats uri /admin?stats
8214 stats realm Haproxy\ Statistics
8215 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
8216 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
8217
8218 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
8219 backend private_monitoring
8220 stats enable
8221 stats uri /admin?stats
8222 stats refresh 5s
8223
8224 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
8225
8226
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008227stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
8228 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01008229 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008230 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008231
8232 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008233 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008234 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
8235 will be analysed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
8236 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
8237
8238 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8239 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8240 the "stick-table" statement.
8241
8242 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
8243 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
8244 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
8245 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
8246 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
8247
8248 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8249 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
8250 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
8251 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
8252 transformation rules.
8253
8254 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8255 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8256 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8257 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8258 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8259 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8260 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8261
8262 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
8263 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
8264 ACL based conditions.
8265
8266 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
8267 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
8268 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
8269 matches can be used as fallbacks.
8270
8271 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
8272 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
8273 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
8274 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
8275
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008276 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8277 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8278 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8279
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008280 Example :
8281 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8282 # last 30 minutes
8283 backend pop
8284 mode tcp
8285 balance roundrobin
8286 stick store-request src
8287 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8288 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8289 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8290
8291 backend smtp
8292 mode tcp
8293 balance roundrobin
8294 stick match src table pop
8295 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8296 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8297
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008298 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008299 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008300
8301
8302stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8303 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
8304 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8305 no | no | yes | yes
8306
8307 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
8308 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
8309 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
8310 for writing more maintainable configurations.
8311
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008312 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8313 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8314 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8315
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008316 Examples :
8317 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +01008318 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008319
8320 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
8321 stick match src table pop if !localhost
8322 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
8323
8324
8325 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
8326 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
8327 backend http
8328 mode http
8329 balance roundrobin
8330 stick on src table https
8331 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
8332 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
8333 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
8334
8335 backend https
8336 mode tcp
8337 balance roundrobin
8338 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8339 stick on src
8340 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8341 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8342
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008343 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008344
8345
8346stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
8347 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
8348 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8349 no | no | yes | yes
8350
8351 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008352 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008353 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
8354 will be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8355 server is selected.
8356
8357 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8358 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8359 the "stick-table" statement.
8360
8361 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8362 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8363 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
8364 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
8365 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
8366 address.
8367
8368 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8369 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
8370 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
8371 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
8372 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
8373 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
8374 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
8375 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
8376 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
8377 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
8378
8379 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8380 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8381 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8382 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8383 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8384 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8385 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8386
8387 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
8388 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8389 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
8390 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8391
8392 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
8393 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8394 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8395 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8396 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8397 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008398 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
8399 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8400 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8401 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8402 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8403 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008404
8405 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
8406 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
8407 the request.
8408
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008409 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
8410 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
8411 processes, which can result in random behaviours.
8412
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008413 Example :
8414 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
8415 # last 30 minutes
8416 backend pop
8417 mode tcp
8418 balance roundrobin
8419 stick store-request src
8420 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
8421 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
8422 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
8423
8424 backend smtp
8425 mode tcp
8426 balance roundrobin
8427 stick match src table pop
8428 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
8429 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
8430
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008431 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008432 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008433
8434
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008435stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008436 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>]
8437 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +08008438 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008439 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008440 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008441
8442 Arguments :
8443 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
8444 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
8445 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8446 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8447
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +01008448 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
8449 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
8450 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
8451 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
8452
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008453 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
8454 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
8455 instance.
8456
8457 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
8458 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
8459 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
8460 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
8461 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
8462 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008463 to 32 characters.
8464
8465 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
8466 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
8467 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008468 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008469 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
8470 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008471
8472 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +02008473 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
8474 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008475 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
8476 increase.
8477
8478 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01008479 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
8480 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
8481 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008482
8483 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
8484 is full. When not specified and the table is full when haproxy
8485 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
8486 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
8487 most often the desired behaviour. In some specific cases, it
8488 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
8489 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
8490 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
8491 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
8492 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
8493 parameter (see below).
8494
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02008495 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
8496 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
8497 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
8498 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
8499 soft restart.
8500
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +02008501 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
8502 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +01008503
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008504 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
8505 was last created, refreshed or matched. The expiration delay is
8506 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
8507 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
8508 section 2.2 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008509 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008510 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
8511 if not expiration delay is specified.
8512
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008513 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
8514 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
8515 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
8516 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008517 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
8518 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
8519 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
8520 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
8521 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
8522 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
8523 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
8524 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
8525 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
8526 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
8527 types and their arguments.
8528
8529 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
8530 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
8531 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
8532 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
8533
8534 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
8535 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
8536 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
8537 specific behaviour was detected and must be known for future matches.
8538
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +02008539 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
8540 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
8541 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
8542 a cumulative count, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
8543 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
8544 occurrence of certain events (eg: requests to a specific URL).
8545
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008546 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8547 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
8548 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
8549 they were received.
8550
8551 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8552 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
8553 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
8554 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
8555 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
8556
8557 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8558 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8559 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8560 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
8561 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8562
8563 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
8564 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
8565 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
8566
8567 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8568 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8569 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8570 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
8571 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8572
8573 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8574 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
8575 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
8576 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
8577 the client side.
8578
8579 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8580 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8581 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8582 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
8583 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
8584 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
8585 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
8586
8587 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
8588 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
8589 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
8590 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
8591 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
8592 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
8593 (eg: vulnerability scan).
8594
8595 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8596 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8597 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8598 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
8599 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
8600 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
8601
8602 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8603 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes received from clients
8604 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
8605 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
8606
8607 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
8608 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8609 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8610 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8611 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8612 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
8613 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
8614 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
8615 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
8616 recommended for better fairness.
8617
8618 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
8619 integer which counts the cumulated amount of bytes sent to clients which
8620 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
8621 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
8622
8623 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
8624 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
8625 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
8626 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
8627 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
8628 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
8629 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
8630 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
8631 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
8632 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +02008633
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +02008634 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
8635 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008636 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
8637 reference it.
8638
8639 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
8640 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +01008641 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
8642 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
8643 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008644
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +02008645 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
8646 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
8647 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
8648 something that can be ignored.
8649
8650 Example:
8651 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
8652 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
8653 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
8654 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
8655
8656 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.2
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +01008657 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +01008658
8659
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008660stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +01008661 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008662 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8663 no | no | yes | yes
8664
8665 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02008666 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008667 describes what elements of the response or connection will
8668 be analysed, extracted and stored in the table once a
8669 server is selected.
8670
8671 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
8672 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
8673 the "stick-table" statement.
8674
8675 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
8676 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
8677 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
8678 when the response is a SSL server hello.
8679
8680 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
8681 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
8682 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
8683 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
8684 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
8685 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008686 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008687 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
8688 rules.
8689
8690 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
8691 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
8692 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
8693 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
8694 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
8695 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
8696 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
8697
8698 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
8699 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
8700 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
8701 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
8702
8703 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
8704 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
8705 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
8706 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
8707 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
8708 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +01008709 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
8710 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
8711 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
8712 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
8713 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
8714 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
8715 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
8716 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
8717 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008718
8719 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
8720
8721 Example :
8722 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
8723 backend https
8724 mode tcp
8725 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008726 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008727 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008728
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008729 acl clienthello req_ssl_hello_type 1
8730 acl serverhello rep_ssl_hello_type 2
8731
8732 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
8733 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
8734 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
8735
8736 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
8737 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008738
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008739 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
8740 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
8741 # at offset 44.
8742
8743 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
8744 stick on payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
8745
8746 # Learn on response if server hello.
8747 stick store-response payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02008748
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +02008749 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
8750 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
8751
8752 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
8753 extraction.
8754
8755
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008756tcp-check connect [params*]
8757 Opens a new connection
8758 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8759 no | no | yes | yes
8760
8761 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
8762 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
8763 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
8764
8765 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
8766 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
8767 of the sequence.
8768
8769 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
8770 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
8771 do.
8772
8773 Parameters :
8774 They are optional and can be used to describe how HAProxy should open and
8775 use the TCP connection.
8776
8777 port if not set, check port or server port is used.
8778 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
8779 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to 65535.
8780
8781 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
8782
8783 ssl opens a ciphered connection
8784
8785 Examples:
8786 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
8787 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
8788 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
8789 option tcp-check
8790 tcp-check connect
8791 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8792 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8793 tcp-check send \r\n
8794 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8795 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
8796 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
8797 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
8798 tcp-check send \r\n
8799 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
8800 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
8801
8802 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
8803 option tcp-check
8804 tcp-check connect port 110
8805 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8806 tcp-check connect port 143
8807 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8808 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
8809
8810 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
8811
8812
8813tcp-check expect [!] <match> <pattern>
8814 Specify data to be collected and analysed during a generic health check
8815 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8816 no | no | yes | yes
8817
8818 Arguments :
8819 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
8820 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring" or
8821 binary.
8822 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
8823 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
8824 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
8825
8826 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
8827 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
8828 with the usual backslash ('\').
8829 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
8830 a serie of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
8831 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
8832 used upper or lower case.
8833
8834
8835 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
8836
8837 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
8838 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8839 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
8840 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8841 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
8842 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
8843 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
8844 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
8845
8846 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
8847 A health check response will be considered valid if the
8848 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
8849 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
8850 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
8851 expression.
8852
8853 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
8854 in the response buffer. A health check response will
8855 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
8856 this exact hexadecimal string.
8857 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
8858
8859 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
8860 defined by the global "tune.chksize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
8861 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
8862 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
8863 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
8864 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
8865 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
8866 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
8867 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
8868 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
8869 the null character.
8870
8871 Examples :
8872 # perform a POP check
8873 option tcp-check
8874 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
8875
8876 # perform an IMAP check
8877 option tcp-check
8878 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
8879
8880 # look for the redis master server
8881 option tcp-check
8882 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02008883 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +02008884 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8885 tcp-check expect string role:master
8886 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
8887 tcp-check expect string +OK
8888
8889
8890 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
8891 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.chksize
8892
8893
8894tcp-check send <data>
8895 Specify a string to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8896 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8897 no | no | yes | yes
8898
8899 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8900 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8901
8902 Examples :
8903 # look for the redis master server
8904 option tcp-check
8905 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
8906 tcp-check expect string role:master
8907
8908 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8909 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.chksize
8910
8911
8912tcp-check send-binary <hexastring>
8913 Specify an hexa digits string to be sent as a binary question during a raw
8914 tcp health check
8915 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8916 no | no | yes | yes
8917
8918 <data> : the data to be sent as a question during a generic health check
8919 session. For now, <data> must be a string.
8920 <hexastring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches in the
8921 response buffer. A health check response will be considered
8922 valid if the response's buffer contains this exact
8923 hexadecimal string.
8924 Purpose is to send binary data to ask on binary protocols.
8925
8926 Examples :
8927 # redis check in binary
8928 option tcp-check
8929 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
8930 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
8931
8932
8933 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
8934 "tcp-check send", tune.chksize
8935
8936
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008937tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
8938 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008939 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8940 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008941 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02008942 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
8943 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +02008944
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008945 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008946
8947 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
8948 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008949 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
8950 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
8951 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
8952 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
8953 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
8954 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008955
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008956 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
8957 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
8958 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
8959 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008960
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02008961 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008962 - accept :
8963 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8964 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8965 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008966
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02008967 - reject :
8968 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
8969 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
8970 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
8971 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
8972 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
8973 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
8974 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
8975 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
8976 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
8977 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
8978 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02008979 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02008980
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02008981 - expect-proxy layer4 :
8982 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
8983 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
8984 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
8985 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
8986 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
8987 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
8988 hosts.
8989
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +01008990 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
8991 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
8992 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
8993 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
8994 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
8995 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
8996 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
8997 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
8998
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02008999 - capture <sample> len <length> :
9000 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
9001 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
9002 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
9003 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
9004 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
9005 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
9006 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
9007 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02009008 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
9009 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009010
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009011 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009012 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02009013 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. 3 sets
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009014 of counters may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection. The
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009015 first "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
9016 specified table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009017 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the second
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009018 set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the
9019 counters of the specified table as the third set. It is a recommended
9020 practice to use the first set of counters for the per-frontend counters
9021 and the second set for the per-backend ones. But this is just a
9022 guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009023
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009024 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +02009025 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +02009026 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009027 request or connection will be analysed, extracted, combined,
9028 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
9029 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
9030 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009031
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009032 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
9033 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
9034 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
9035 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009036
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009037 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
9038 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
9039 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
9040 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
9041 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009042 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
9043 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
9044 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
9045 layer7 information is extracted.
9046
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009047 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
9048 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
9049 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
9050 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
9051 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009052
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009053 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9054 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9055 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
9056 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
9057
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009058 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>:
9059 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9060 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9061 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9062 continues.
9063
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009064 - set-src <expr> :
9065 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
9066 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
9067 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9068 set-src"
9069
9070 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9071 followed by some converters.
9072
9073 Example:
9074
9075 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
9076
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009077 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
9078 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +02009079
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009080 - set-src-port <expr> :
9081 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
9082 expression.
9083
9084 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9085 followed by some converters.
9086
9087 Example:
9088
9089 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
9090
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009091 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
9092 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
9093 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02009094
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009095 - set-dst <expr> :
9096 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
9097 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
9098 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
9099 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9100 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9101
9102 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9103 followed by some converters.
9104
9105 Example:
9106
9107 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
9108 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
9109
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009110 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
9111 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
9112
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02009113 - set-dst-port <expr> :
9114 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
9115 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
9116 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
9117
9118
9119 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9120 followed by some converters.
9121
9122 Example:
9123
9124 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
9125
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +02009126 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
9127 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
9128 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
9129
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009130 - "silent-drop" :
9131 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
9132 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
9133 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9134 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9135 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9136 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9137 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
9138 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
9139 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
9140 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9141 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
9142 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
9143 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9144 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9145 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9146 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9147
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009148 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9149 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9150 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009151
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009152 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9153 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
9154 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009155
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009156 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009157 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009158 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009159
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009160 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
9161 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9162 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009163
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009164 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009165 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9166 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009167
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +02009168 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
9169
9170 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9171
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009172 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9173
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009174 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009175
9176
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009177tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9178 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009179 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009180 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009181 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009182 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9183 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009184
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009185 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009186
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009187 A request's contents can be analysed at an early stage of request processing
9188 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9189 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
9190 "accept" or a "reject" rule matches, or the TCP request inspection delay
9191 expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009192
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009193 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
9194 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
9195 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
9196 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009197 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
9198 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so haproxy keeps a record of
9199 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
9200 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
9201 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
9202 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009203 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009204 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009205
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009206 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9207 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9208 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9209 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009210
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009211 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +02009212 - accept : the request is accepted
9213 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9214 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009215 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009216 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Thierry Fournierb9125672016-03-29 19:34:37 +02009217 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009218 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009219 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009220 - silent-drop
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009221
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009222 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
9223 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009224
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009225 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
9226 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
9227 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
9228 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
9229 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
9230 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009231
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009232 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009233 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9234 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009235
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009236 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009237 rules, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to preliminarily parse the
9238 contents of a buffer before extracting the required data. If the buffered
9239 contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the ACL does not match.
9240 The parser which is involved there is exactly the same as for all other HTTP
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +01009241 processing, so there is no risk of parsing something differently. In an HTTP
9242 backend connected to from an HTTP frontend, it is guaranteed that HTTP
9243 contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated first.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009244
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009245 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009246 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
9247 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
9248 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009249
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009250 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009251 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
9252 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009253
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009254 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9255 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009256 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009257 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9258 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009259 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009260 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009261 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009262 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9263 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009264 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009265 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9266 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009267
9268 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9269 followed by some converters.
9270
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009271 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9272 <var-name>.
9273
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009274 Example:
9275
9276 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009277 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009278
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009279 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009280 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
9281 # and reject everything else.
9282 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
9283 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +02009284 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009285 tcp-request content reject
9286
9287 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009288 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
9289 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9290 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009291 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009292
9293 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
9294 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
9295 acl content_present req_len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +02009296 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009297 tcp-request content reject
9298
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009299 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009300 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009301 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009302 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009303 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
9304 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009305
9306 Example:
9307 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
9308 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +02009309 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +01009310
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009311 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009312 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009313
9314 frontend http
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009315 # Use General Purpose Couter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009316 # protecting all our sites
9317 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009318 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
9319 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009320 ...
9321 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
9322
9323 backend http_dynamic
9324 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009325 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009326 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009327 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009328 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +02009329 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02009330 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009331
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009332 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009333
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +03009334 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
9335 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009336
9337
9338tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
9339 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
9340 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009341 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009342 Arguments :
9343 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9344 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9345 as explained at the top of this document.
9346
9347 People using haproxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
9348 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
9349 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
9350 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
9351 data for at most the specified amount of time.
9352
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +02009353 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
9354 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
9355 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
9356 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
9357
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009358 Note that when performing content inspection, haproxy will evaluate the whole
9359 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009360 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009361 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +01009362 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, haproxy will not wait at all
9363 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
9364 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
9365 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009366
9367 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
9368 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
9369 it pass through unaffected.
9370
9371 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
9372 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
9373 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009374 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009375 before the server (eg: SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
9376 data to the server (eg: SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +02009377 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
9378 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
9379 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009380
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009381 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +02009382 "timeout client".
9383
9384
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009385tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9386 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
9387 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9388 no | no | yes | yes
9389 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +02009390 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9391 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009392
9393 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9394
9395 Response contents can be analysed at an early stage of response processing
9396 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
9397 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009398 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
9399 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009400
9401 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
9402
9403 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
9404 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
9405 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
9406 inserted.
9407
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009408 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009409 - accept :
9410 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9411 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
9412 the rules evaluation.
9413
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009414 - close :
9415 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
9416 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
9417 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
9418 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
9419 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
9420 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009421 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +02009422 protocols.
9423
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009424 - reject :
9425 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
9426 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009427 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009428
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009429 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
9430 Sets a variable.
9431
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009432 - unset-var(<var-name>)
9433 Unsets a variable.
9434
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02009435 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
9436 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
9437 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
9438 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
9439
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02009440 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int> :
9441 This action sets the GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter designated
9442 by <sc-id> and the value of <int>. The expected result is a boolean. If
9443 an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions evaluation
9444 continues.
9445
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02009446 - "silent-drop" :
9447 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
9448 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependant way that tries
9449 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
9450 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
9451 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
9452 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
9453 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
9454 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to undestand the impact
9455 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipments placed between the
9456 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
9457 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
9458 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
9459 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
9460 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
9461 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
9462 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
9463
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009464 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9465 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9466 for changing the default action to a reject.
9467
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009468 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
9469 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
9470 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
9471 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009472 period.
9473
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009474 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
9475 declared inline.
9476
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009477 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
9478 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01009479 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009480 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
9481 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009482 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009483 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009484 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01009485 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
9486 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009487 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +01009488 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
9489 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02009490
9491 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
9492 followed by some converters.
9493
9494 Example:
9495
9496 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
9497
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009498 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
9499 <var-name>.
9500
9501 Example:
9502
9503 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var)
9504
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009505 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9506
9507 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
9508
9509
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009510tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
9511 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
9512 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9513 no | yes | yes | no
9514 Arguments :
9515 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
9516 below.
9517
9518 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
9519
9520 Once a session is validated, (ie. after all handshakes have been completed),
9521 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
9522 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
9523 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
9524 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
9525 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
9526 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
9527 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
9528 from the PROXY protocol header (eg: track a source forwarded this way). The
9529 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
9530 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
9531 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
9532 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
9533 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
9534 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
9535 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
9536 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
9537 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
9538 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
9539 instead.
9540
9541 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
9542 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
9543 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
9544 rules which may be inserted.
9545
9546 Several types of actions are supported :
9547 - accept : the request is accepted
9548 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
9549 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
9550 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
9551 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) <int>
9552 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01009553 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02009554 - silent-drop
9555
9556 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
9557 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
9558 sections for a complete description.
9559
9560 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
9561 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
9562 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
9563
9564 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
9565 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
9566 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
9567 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
9568 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
9569
9570 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
9571 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9572
9573 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
9574 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
9575 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
9576
9577 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9578 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
9579 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9580
9581 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
9582 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
9583 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
9584
9585 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
9586 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
9587 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
9588
9589 See section 7 about ACL usage.
9590
9591 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
9592
9593
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02009594tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
9595 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
9596 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9597 no | no | yes | yes
9598 Arguments :
9599 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9600 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9601 as explained at the top of this document.
9602
9603 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
9604
9605
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009606timeout check <timeout>
9607 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
9608 established.
9609
9610 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9611 yes | no | yes | yes
9612 Arguments:
9613 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9614 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9615 as explained at the top of this document.
9616
9617 If set, haproxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
9618 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
9619 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (eg. those
9620 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +01009621 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
9622 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
9623 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009624
9625 If "timeout check" is not set haproxy uses "inter" for complete check
9626 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
9627
9628 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
9629 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009630 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009631
9632 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9633 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9634 forget about it.
9635
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009636 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
9637 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009638
9639
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009640timeout client <timeout>
9641timeout clitimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9642 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
9643 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9644 yes | yes | yes | no
9645 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009646 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009647 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9648 as explained at the top of this document.
9649
9650 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9651 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9652 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009653 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
9654 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
9655 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
9656 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009657 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
9658 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
9659 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009660 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009661 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009662 (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
9663 sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009664 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
9665 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009666
9667 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9668 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9669 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9670 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9671 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9672 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9673
9674 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "clitimeout". It is recommended
9675 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout clitimeout" is
9676 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9677
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +01009678 See also : "clitimeout", "timeout server", "timeout tunnel",
9679 "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009680
9681
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009682timeout client-fin <timeout>
9683 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
9684 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9685 yes | yes | yes | no
9686 Arguments :
9687 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9688 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9689 as explained at the top of this document.
9690
9691 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
9692 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9693 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9694 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9695 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
9696 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9697 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9698 down in one direction.
9699
9700 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
9701 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9702 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
9703
9704 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
9705
9706
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009707timeout connect <timeout>
9708timeout contimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9709 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
9710 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9711 yes | no | yes | yes
9712 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009713 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009714 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9715 as explained at the top of this document.
9716
9717 If the server is located on the same LAN as haproxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009718 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009719 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009720 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +01009721 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
9722 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009723
9724 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9725 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9726 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9727 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9728 during startup because it may results in accumulation of failed sessions in
9729 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9730
9731 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "contimeout". It is recommended
9732 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout contimeout" is
9733 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9734
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +01009735 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "contimeout",
9736 "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01009737
9738
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009739timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
9740 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
9741 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9742 yes | yes | yes | yes
9743 Arguments :
9744 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9745 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9746 as explained at the top of this document.
9747
9748 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
9749 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
9750 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
9751 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
9752 once the request has started to present itself.
9753
9754 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
9755 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
9756 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
9757 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
9758 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
9759
9760 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
9761 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
9762 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
9763 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
9764
9765 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
9766 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
9767 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (eg:
9768 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
9769 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +02009770 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009771
9772 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
9773 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
9774 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
9775 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
9776
9777 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
9778
9779
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009780timeout http-request <timeout>
9781 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
9782 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009783 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009784 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009785 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009786 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9787 as explained at the top of this document.
9788
9789 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
9790 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
9791 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
9792 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
9793 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
9794 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
9795 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +02009796 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
9797 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
9798 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
9799 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
9800 standard, well-documented behaviour, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009801 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
9802 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009803
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009804 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
9805 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
9806 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
9807 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
9808 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01009809 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009810
9811 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
9812 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
9813 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (eg: 50 ms) will
9814 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
9815 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
9816
9817 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +02009818 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
9819 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
9820 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009821
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02009822 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +01009823 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +01009824
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009825
9826timeout queue <timeout>
9827 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
9828 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9829 yes | no | yes | yes
9830 Arguments :
9831 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9832 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9833 as explained at the top of this document.
9834
9835 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
9836 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
9837 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
9838 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
9839 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
9840
9841 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
9842 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
9843 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
9844 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
9845
9846 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9847
9848
9849timeout server <timeout>
9850timeout srvtimeout <timeout> (deprecated)
9851 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
9852 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9853 yes | no | yes | yes
9854 Arguments :
9855 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9856 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9857 as explained at the top of this document.
9858
9859 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9860 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
9861 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
9862 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
9863 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
9864 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
9865 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
9866
9867 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9868 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9869 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
9870 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
9871 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01009872 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009873 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009874 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
9875 with short-lived sessions (eg: WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
9876 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
9877 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009878
9879 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9880 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9881 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
9882 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
9883 during startup because it may results in accumulation of expired sessions in
9884 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
9885
9886 This parameter replaces the old, deprecated "srvtimeout". It is recommended
9887 to use it to write new configurations. The form "timeout srvtimeout" is
9888 provided only by backwards compatibility but its use is strongly discouraged.
9889
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009890 See also : "srvtimeout", "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009891
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009892
9893timeout server-fin <timeout>
9894 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
9895 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9896 yes | no | yes | yes
9897 Arguments :
9898 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9899 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9900 as explained at the top of this document.
9901
9902 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
9903 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
9904 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
9905 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
9906 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
9907 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
9908 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
9909 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
9910 situations, it should not be needed.
9911
9912 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9913 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
9914 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
9915
9916 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
9917
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009918
9919timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009920 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009921 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9922 yes | yes | yes | yes
9923 Arguments :
9924 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
9925 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9926 as explained at the top of this document.
9927
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009928 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit" or
9929 "reqtarpit", it is maintained open with no activity for a certain
9930 amount of time, then closed. "timeout tarpit" defines how long it will
9931 be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009932
9933 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9934 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9935 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
9936 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01009937 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009938
9939 See also : "timeout connect", "contimeout".
9940
9941
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009942timeout tunnel <timeout>
9943 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
9944 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9945 yes | no | yes | yes
9946 Arguments :
9947 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
9948 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
9949 as explained at the top of this document.
9950
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009951 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009952 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
9953 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
9954 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
9955 analyser remains attached to either connection (eg: tcp content rules are
9956 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (eg:
9957 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
9958 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
9959 specified.
9960
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009961 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
9962 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
9963 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
9964 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
9965 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
9966 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
9967 state.
9968
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009969 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
9970 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
9971 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
9972 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
9973 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (eg: 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
9974
9975 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
9976 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
9977 forget about it.
9978
9979 Example :
9980 defaults http
9981 option http-server-close
9982 timeout connect 5s
9983 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009984 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009985 timeout server 30s
9986 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
9987
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02009988 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009989
9990
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009991transparent (deprecated)
9992 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9993 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009994 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009995 Arguments : none
9996
9997 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
9998 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9999 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
10000 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
10001 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
10002 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
10003 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
10004 appropriate server.
10005
10006 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
10007
10008 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
10009 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
10010
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010011 See also: "option transparent"
10012
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010013unique-id-format <string>
10014 Generate a unique ID for each request.
10015 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10016 yes | yes | yes | no
10017 Arguments :
10018 <string> is a log-format string.
10019
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010020 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
10021 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
10022 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
10023 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010024
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010025 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
10026 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple haproxy instances
10027 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
10028 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
10029 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
10030 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
10031 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
10032 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010033
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010034 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
10035 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010036
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010037 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010038
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010039 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010040
10041 will generate:
10042
10043 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10044
10045 See also: "unique-id-header"
10046
10047unique-id-header <name>
10048 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
10049 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10050 yes | yes | yes | no
10051 Arguments :
10052 <name> is the name of the header.
10053
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010054 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
10055 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010056
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010057 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010058
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050010059 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010010060 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
10061
10062 will generate:
10063
10064 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
10065
10066 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010067
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010068use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010069 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010070 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10071 no | yes | yes | no
10072 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010073 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
10074 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010075
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020010076 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
10077 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010078
10079 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
10080 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
10081 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020010082 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
10083 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (eg:
10084 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
10085 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010086
10087 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
10088 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
10089 assign the backend.
10090
10091 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
10092 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10093 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
10094 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
10095 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
10096 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
10097
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010098 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010099 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020010100 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
10101 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
10102 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
10103
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010104 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
10105 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
10106 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
10107 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
10108 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
10109 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
10110 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
10111 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
10112 cannot be forced from the request.
10113
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010114 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010010115 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
10116 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
10117
10118 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
10119 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010010120
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010010121
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010122use-server <server> if <condition>
10123use-server <server> unless <condition>
10124 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
10125 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10126 no | no | yes | yes
10127 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020010128 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010129
10130 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
10131
10132 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
10133 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
10134 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
10135
10136 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
10137 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
10138 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
10139 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
10140 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
10141 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
10142 matches will assign the server.
10143
10144 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
10145 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
10146 with the next rules until one matches.
10147
10148 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
10149 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
10150 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
10151 according to other persistence mechanisms.
10152
10153 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
10154 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
10155 stripped.
10156
10157 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
10158 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
10159 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field. And if these servers
10160 have their weight set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
10161
10162 Example :
10163 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
10164 use-server www if { req_ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
10165 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
10166 use-server mail if { req_ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
10167 server mail 192.168.0.1:587 weight 0
10168 use-server imap if { req_ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000010169 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010170 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
10171 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
10172
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010173 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010174
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010175
101765. Bind and Server options
10177--------------------------
10178
10179The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
10180depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
10181settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
10182written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
10183described in this section.
10184
10185
101865.1. Bind options
10187-----------------
10188
10189The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
10190as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
10191no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
10192parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
10193while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
10194provided immediately after the setting name.
10195
10196The currently supported settings are the following ones.
10197
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010198accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
10199 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
10200 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
10201 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
10202 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
10203 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
10204 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
10205 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
10206 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
10207 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010010208 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
10209 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
10210 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010010211
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010212accept-proxy
10213 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020010214 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
10215 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010216 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
10217 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
10218 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
10219 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
10220 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
10221 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
10222 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020010223 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
10224 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010225
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010226alpn <protocols>
10227 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
10228 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
10229 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
10230 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS
10231 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
10232 initial NPN extension.
10233
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010234backlog <backlog>
10235 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified, the frontend's
10236 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
10237
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010010238curves <curves>
10239 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10240 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
10241 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
10242 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
10243 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
10244 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
10245
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010246ecdhe <named curve>
10247 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010010248 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
10249 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020010250
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010251ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010252 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10253 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10254 client's certificate.
10255
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010256ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
10257 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10258 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
10259 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
10260 error is ignored.
10261
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010262ca-sign-file <cafile>
10263 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10264 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
10265 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
10266 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10267 'generate-certificates' for details.
10268
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000010269ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010270 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
10271 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
10272 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
10273 'generate-certificates' for details.
10274
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010275ciphers <ciphers>
10276 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
10277 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010278 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake. The format of the string is defined
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010279 in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages, and can be for instance a string
10280 such as "AES:ALL:!aNULL:!eNULL:+RC4:@STRENGTH" (without quotes).
10281
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010282crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010283 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10284 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10285 to verify client's certificate.
10286
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010287crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010288 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10289 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
10290 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
10291 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
10292 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
10293 file.
10294
10295 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
10296 are loaded.
10297
10298 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010299 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends with
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010300 '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This directive may be
10301 specified multiple times in order to load certificates from multiple files or
10302 directories. The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a
10303 valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their CN or alt
10304 subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*' is used
10305 instead of the first hostname component (eg: *.example.org matches
10306 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010307
10308 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
10309 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
10310 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
10311 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010010312 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
10313 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010314
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020010315 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010316
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010317 Some CAs (such as Godaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
10318 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Godbach8bf60a12014-04-21 21:42:41 +080010319 choose a webserver that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010320 Godaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
10321 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
10322 clients).
10323
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020010324 For each PEM file, haproxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
10325 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
10326 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
10327 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
10328 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
10329 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
10330 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
10331 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
10332 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
10333 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
10334 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
10335 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
10336 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
10337
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010010338 For each PEM file, haproxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
10339 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
10340 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
10341 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
10342 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
10343
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010344 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
10345 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
10346 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
10347 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010348
10349 In order to provide this functionality, multiple PEM files, each with a
10350 different key type, are required. To associate these PEM files into a
10351 "cert bundle" that is recognized by haproxy, they must be named in the
10352 following way: All PEM files that are to be bundled must have the same base
10353 name, with a suffix indicating the key type. Currently, three suffixes are
10354 supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For example, if www.example.com has two PEM
10355 files, an RSA file and an ECDSA file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa"
10356 and "example.pem.ecdsa". The first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the
10357 suffix matters. To load this bundle into haproxy, specify the base name only:
10358
10359 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
10360
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010361 Note that the suffix is not given to haproxy; this tells haproxy to look for
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010362 a cert bundle.
10363
10364 Haproxy will load all PEM files in the bundle at the same time to try to
10365 support multiple key types. PEM files are combined based on Common Name
10366 (CN) and Subject Alternative Name (SAN) to support SNI lookups. This means
10367 that even if you give haproxy a cert bundle, if there are no shared CN/SAN
10368 entries in the certificates in that bundle, haproxy will not be able to
10369 provide multi-cert support.
10370
10371 Assuming bundle in the example above contained the following:
10372
10373 Filename | CN | SAN
10374 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10375 example.pem.rsa | www.example.com | rsa.example.com
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010376 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010377 example.pem.ecdsa | www.example.com | ecdsa.example.com
10378 -------------------+-----------------+-------------------
10379
10380 Users connecting with an SNI of "www.example.com" will be able
10381 to use both RSA and ECDSA cipher suites. Users connecting with an SNI of
10382 "rsa.example.com" will only be able to use RSA cipher suites, and users
10383 connecting with "ecdsa.example.com" will only be able to use ECDSA cipher
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010384 suites. With BoringSSL multi-cert is natively supported, no need to bundle
10385 certificates. ECDSA certificate will be preferred if client support it.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010386
10387 If a directory name is given as the <cert> argument, haproxy will
10388 automatically search and load bundled files in that directory.
10389
10390 OSCP files (.ocsp) and issuer files (.issuer) are supported with multi-cert
10391 bundling. Each certificate can have its own .ocsp and .issuer file. At this
10392 time, sctl is not supported in multi-certificate bundling.
10393
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010394crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010395 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
10396 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010397 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000010398 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020010399
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010400crt-list <file>
10401 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010402 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
10403 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010404
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010405 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
10406
10407 sslbindconf support "npn", "alpn", "verify", "ca_file", "crl_file", "ecdhe",
Emmanuel Hocdet4608ed92017-01-20 13:06:27 +010010408 "curves", "ciphers" configuration.
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010409 It override the configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010410
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020010411 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
10412 only useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI.
10413 The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid TLS Server
10414 Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI filter is
10415 specified, the CN and alt subjects are used. This directive may be specified
10416 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
10417 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
10418 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010010419
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050010420 Multi-cert bundling (see "crt") is supported with crt-list, as long as only
Emmanuel Hocdetd294aea2016-05-13 11:14:06 +020010421 the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do the same work on
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010422 all bundled certificates. With BoringSSL multi-cert is natively supported,
10423 avoid multi-cert bundling. RSA and ECDSA certificates can be declared in a
10424 row, and set different ssl and filter parameter.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050010425
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010426 crt-list file example:
10427 cert1.pem
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010428 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010429 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010010430 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010010431
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010432defer-accept
10433 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10434 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
10435 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
10436 for which the client talks first (eg: HTTP). It can slightly improve
10437 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
10438 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
10439 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
10440 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
10441 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
10442 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
10443 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
10444
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020010445expose-fd listeners
10446 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
10447 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020010448 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
10449 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020010450 See alors "-x" in the management guide.
10451
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010452force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010453 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010454 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010455 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010456 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010457
10458force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010459 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010460 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010461 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010462
10463force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010464 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010465 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010466 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010467
10468force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010469 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010470 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010471 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010472
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010473force-tlsv13
10474 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
10475 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010476 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010477
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020010478generate-certificates
10479 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10480 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
10481 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
10482 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
10483 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
10484 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
10485 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
10486 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
10487 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
10488 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
10489 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
10490
10491 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
10492 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
10493 increases the HAProxy's memroy footprint to reduce latency when the same
10494 certificate is used many times.
10495
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010496gid <gid>
10497 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
10498 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10499 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
10500 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
10501 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10502
10503group <group>
10504 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
10505 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
10506 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
10507 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
10508 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10509
10510id <id>
10511 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
10512 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
10513 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
10514 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
10515
10516interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010010517 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
10518 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
10519 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
10520 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
10521 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
10522 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
10523 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010524
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020010525level <level>
10526 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
10527 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
10528 sockets. <level> can be one of :
10529 - "user" is the least privileged level ; only non-sensitive stats can be
10530 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
10531 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
10532 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
10533 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (eg: clear max
10534 counters).
10535 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (eg: clear
10536 all counters).
10537
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010538maxconn <maxconn>
10539 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
10540 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
10541 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
10542 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
10543 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
10544 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
10545 eat all memory.
10546
10547mode <mode>
10548 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
10549 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
10550 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
10551 UNIX sockets.
10552
10553mss <maxseg>
10554 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
10555 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
10556 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
10557 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
10558 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
10559 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
10560 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
10561 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
10562 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
10563 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
10564 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
10565
10566name <name>
10567 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
10568 page.
10569
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020010570namespace <name>
10571 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
10572 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
10573 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
10574 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
10575
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010576nice <nice>
10577 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
10578 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
10579 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
10580 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
10581 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
10582 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
10583 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
10584 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
10585 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
10586 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
10587 one for an RDP socket.
10588
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010589no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010590 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010591 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010592 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010593 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010594 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
10595 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010596
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010597no-tls-tickets
10598 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10599 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
10600 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010601 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
10602 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020010603
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010604no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010605 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010606 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010607 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010608 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010609 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10610 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010611
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010612no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010613 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010614 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010615 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010616 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010617 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10618 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010619
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020010620no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010621 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010622 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020010623 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010010624 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010625 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10626 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020010627
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010628no-tlsv13
10629 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10630 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
10631 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
10632 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010633 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
10634 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020010635
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010636npn <protocols>
10637 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
10638 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
10639 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
10640 This requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020010641 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
10642 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword).
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020010643
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000010644prefer-client-ciphers
10645 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
10646 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
10647 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
10648
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010649process [ all | odd | even | <number 1-64>[-<number 1-64>] ]
10650 This restricts the list of processes on which this listener is allowed to
10651 run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do not match.
10652 If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection between the
10653 two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run on any
10654 remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either run on
10655 the first process of the listener if a single process was specified, or on
10656 all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. For the unlikely
Willy Tarreauae302532014-05-07 19:22:24 +020010657 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated. The
10658 main purpose of this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have
10659 one different socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind
10660 lines sharing the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so
10661 that the system can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues
10662 and allow a smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and
10663 above is known for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020010664
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010665ssl
10666 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010667 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010668 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
10669 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
10670 to deciphered contents.
10671
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020010672ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
10673 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
10674 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10675 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
10676
10677ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
10678 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections instantiated
10679 from this listener. This option is also available on global statement
10680 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
10681
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010010682strict-sni
10683 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
10684 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
10685 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
10686 See the "crt" option for more information.
10687
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010688tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010010689 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010690 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
10691 allows haproxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010010692 receiving an acknowledgement for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010010693 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
10694 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
10695 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
10696 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
10697 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
10698 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
10699 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
10700
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010701tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010010702 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010703 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
10704 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
10705 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
10706 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
10707 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
10708 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
10709 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020010710 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
10711 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
10712 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020010713
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010010714tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
10715 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
10716 bytes long, encoded with base64 (ex. openssl rand -base64 48). Number of keys
10717 is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO build option (default 3) and at least as
10718 many keys need to be present in the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be
10719 used for decryption and the penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy
10720 key rotation by just appending new key to the file and reloading the process.
10721 Keys must be periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy
10722 is compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
10723 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
10724 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
10725
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010726transparent
10727 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
10728 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
10729 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
10730 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
10731 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
10732 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
10733 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
10734 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
10735 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
10736 so check for support with your vendor.
10737
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010738v4v6
10739 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10740 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
10741 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
10742 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010743 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010744
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010745v6only
10746 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
10747 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
10748 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010010749 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
10750 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010010751
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010752uid <uid>
10753 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
10754 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10755 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
10756 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
10757 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10758
10759user <user>
10760 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
10761 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
10762 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
10763 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
10764 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
10765
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020010766verify [none|optional|required]
10767 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
10768 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
10769 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
10770 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
10771 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020010772 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
10773 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
10774 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
10775 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020010776
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200107775.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010010778------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010779
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010780The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
10781which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
10782arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
10783settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
10784after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
10785Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
10786address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010787
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010788 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010010789 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010790
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010791Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
10792keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
10793
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010794The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010010795
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020010796addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010797 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010010798 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
10799 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
10800 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
10801 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
10802 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020010803
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010804agent-check
10805 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010806 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
10807 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string.
10808 The string is made of a series of words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas
10809 in any order, optionally terminated by '\r' and/or '\n', each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010810
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010811 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010812 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020010813 weight of a server as configured when haproxy starts. Note that a zero
10814 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
10815 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010816
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020010817 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values in
10818 this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
10819 connections advertised needs to be multipled by the number of load balancers
10820 and different backends that use this health check to get the total number
10821 of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
10822
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010823 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10824 READY mode, thus cancelling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010825
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010826 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10827 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
10828 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010829
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010830 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
10831 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
10832 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010833
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010834 - The words "down", "failed", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
10835 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
10836 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
10837 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
10838 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
10839 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (eg: missing process,
10840 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010841
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010842 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
10843 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010844
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010845 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
10846 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
10847 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
10848 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
10849 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
10850 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
10851 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
10852 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
10853 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010854
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010855 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
10856 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010857 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
10858 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
10859 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010010860 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090010861
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010010862 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010863 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010864
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070010865agent-send <string>
10866 If this option is specified, haproxy will send the given string (verbatim)
10867 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
10868 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
10869 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
10870 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
10871
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010872agent-inter <delay>
10873 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
10874 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
10875
10876 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
10877 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
10878 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
10879 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
10880 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
10881 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
10882 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
10883 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
10884 of backends use the same servers.
10885
10886 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
10887
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010010888agent-addr <addr>
10889 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
10890
10891 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
10892 managing status and weights of servers defined in haproxy in case you can't
10893 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
10894 hostname, it will be resolved.
10895
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090010896agent-port <port>
10897 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
10898
10899 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
10900
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010901backup
10902 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
10903 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
10904 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
10905 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010906 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
10907 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010908
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010909ca-file <cafile>
10910 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10911 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
10912 server's certificate.
10913
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010914check
10915 This option enables health checks on the server. By default, a server is
Patrick Mézardb7aeec62012-01-22 16:01:22 +010010916 always considered available. If "check" is set, the server is available when
10917 accepting periodic TCP connections, to ensure that it is really able to serve
10918 requests. The default address and port to send the tests to are those of the
10919 server, and the default source is the same as the one defined in the
10920 backend. It is possible to change the address using the "addr" parameter, the
10921 port using the "port" parameter, the source address using the "source"
10922 address, and the interval and timers using the "inter", "rise" and "fall"
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +090010923 parameters. The request method is define in the backend using the "httpchk",
10924 "smtpchk", "mysql-check", "pgsql-check" and "ssl-hello-chk" options. Please
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010925 refer to those options and parameters for more information. See also
10926 "no-check" option.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010927
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020010928check-send-proxy
10929 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
10930 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
10931 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
10932 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
10933 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
10934 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
10935 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
10936
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010937check-ssl
10938 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
10939 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
10940 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
10941 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010942 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010943 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
10944 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
10945 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (eg: ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010946 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
10947 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020010948
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010949ciphers <ciphers>
10950 This option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010951 is negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020010952 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers". When SSL is used to communicate with
10953 servers on the local network, it is common to see a weaker set of algorithms
10954 than what is used over the internet. Doing so reduces CPU usage on both the
10955 server and haproxy while still keeping it compatible with deployed software.
10956 Some algorithms such as RC4-SHA1 are reasonably cheap. If no security at all
10957 is needed and just connectivity, using DES can be appropriate.
10958
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010959cookie <value>
10960 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
10961 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
10962 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
10963 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
10964 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
10965 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
10966 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
10967
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020010968crl-file <crlfile>
10969 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
10970 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
10971 to verify server's certificate.
10972
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020010973crt <cert>
10974 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
10975 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
10976 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
10977 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
10978 certificate request.
10979
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020010980disabled
10981 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
10982 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
10983 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
10984 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
10985 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010986 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020010987
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010010988enabled
10989 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
10990 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
10991 default value.
10992 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
10993 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020010994
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010010995error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010996 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
10997 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
10998 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010010999
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011000 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011001
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011002fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011003 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
11004 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
11005 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
11006
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011007force-sslv3
11008 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11009 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011010 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011011 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011012
11013force-tlsv10
11014 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011015 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011016 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011017
11018force-tlsv11
11019 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011020 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011021 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011022
11023force-tlsv12
11024 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011025 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011026 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011027
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011028force-tlsv13
11029 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
11030 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011031 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011032
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011033id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020011034 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
11035 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
11036 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011037
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010011038init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
11039 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
11040 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
11041 turn each of the methods mentionned in the comma-delimited list. The first
11042 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
11043 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
11044 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
11045 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
11046 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
11047 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
11048 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
11049 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
11050 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
11051 server (eg: filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
11052 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
11053 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
11054 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
11055 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
11056 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
11057 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
11058 historic behaviour.
11059
11060 Example:
11061 defaults
11062 # never fail on address resolution
11063 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
11064
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011065inter <delay>
11066fastinter <delay>
11067downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011068 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
11069 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
11070 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
11071 between checks depending on the server state :
11072
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020011073 Server state | Interval used
11074 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11075 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
11076 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11077 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
11078 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
11079 or yet unchecked. |
11080 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
11081 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
11082 | "inter" otherwise.
11083 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011084
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011085 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
11086 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
11087 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
11088 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090011089 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
11090 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
11091 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
11092 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
11093 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011094
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011095maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011096 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
11097 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
11098 concurrent requests goes higher than this value, they will be queued, waiting
11099 for a connection to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
11100 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
11101 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
11102 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
11103 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
11104
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011105maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011106 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
11107 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
11108 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
11109 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
11110 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. The
11111 default value is "0" which means the queue is unlimited. See also the
11112 "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters.
11113
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011114minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011115 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
11116 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
11117 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
11118 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
11119 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
11120 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011121 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011122 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011123
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020011124namespace <name>
11125 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
11126 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
11127 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
11128 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
11129
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011130no-agent-check
11131 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
11132 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11133 default value.
11134 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11135 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
11136
11137no-backup
11138 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
11139 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11140 default value.
11141 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11142 "default-server" "backup" setting.
11143
11144no-check
11145 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
11146 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11147 default value.
11148 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11149 "default-server" "check" setting.
11150
11151no-check-ssl
11152 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
11153 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11154 default value.
11155 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11156 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
11157
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011158no-send-proxy
11159 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
11160 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11161 default value.
11162 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11163 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
11164
11165no-send-proxy-v2
11166 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
11167 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11168 default value.
11169 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11170 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
11171
11172no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
11173 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
11174 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11175 default value.
11176 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11177 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
11178
11179no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11180 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
11181 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11182 default value.
11183 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11184 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
11185
11186no-ssl
11187 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
11188 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11189 default value.
11190 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11191 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
11192
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010011193no-ssl-reuse
11194 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
11195 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
11196 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
11197 and for paranoid users.
11198
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011199no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011200 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11201 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011202 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011203
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011204 Supported in default-server: No
11205
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011206no-tls-tickets
11207 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
11208 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
11209 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011210 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
11211 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011212 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020011213
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011214no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011215 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011216 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11217 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011218 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11219 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011220 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011221
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011222 Supported in default-server: No
11223
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011224no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011225 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020011226 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11227 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011228 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11229 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011230 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011231
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011232 Supported in default-server: No
11233
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020011234no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020011235 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011236 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11237 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010011238 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11239 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011240 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020011241
11242 Supported in default-server: No
11243
11244no-tlsv13
11245 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
11246 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
11247 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
11248 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
11249 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011250 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011251
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020011252 Supported in default-server: No
11253
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011254no-verifyhost
11255 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
11256 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11257 default value.
11258 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11259 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011260
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090011261non-stick
11262 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
11263 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
11264 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
11265
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011266observe <mode>
11267 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
11268 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
11269 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
11270 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
11271 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
11272 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010011273 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011274
11275 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
11276
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011277on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010011278 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
11279 Currently, four modes are available:
11280 - fastinter: force fastinter
11281 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
11282 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
11283 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
11284 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
11285
11286 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
11287
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011288on-marked-down <action>
11289 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
11290 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011291 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
11292 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
11293 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
11294 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
11295 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
11296 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
11297 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
11298 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090011299
11300 Actions are disabled by default
11301
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070011302on-marked-up <action>
11303 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
11304 Currently one action is available:
11305 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
11306 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
11307 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
11308 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
11309 with long sessions (eg: LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
11310 than it tries to solve (eg: incomplete transactions), so use this feature
11311 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
11312 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
11313
11314 Actions are disabled by default
11315
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011316port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011317 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
11318 send health-checks. On some servers, it may be desirable to dedicate a port
11319 to a specific component able to perform complex tests which are more suitable
11320 to health-checks than the application. It is common to run a simple script in
11321 inetd for instance. This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not
11322 set. See also the "addr" parameter.
11323
11324redir <prefix>
11325 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
11326 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
11327 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
11328 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
11329 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
11330 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
11331 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
11332 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011333 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011334 requests are still analysed, making this solution completely usable to direct
11335 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
11336 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
11337 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
11338 loop between the client and HAProxy!
11339
11340 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
11341
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011342rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011343 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
11344 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
11345 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
11346
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011347resolve-prefer <family>
11348 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
11349 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
11350 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
11351 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
11352
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020011353 Default value: ipv6
11354
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011355 Example:
11356
11357 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011358
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011359resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
11360 This options prioritize th choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
11361 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011362 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011363 differents datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
11364 this patch permitsto prefers a local datacenter. If none address matchs the
11365 configured network, another address is selected.
11366
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011367 Example:
11368
11369 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010011370
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011371resolvers <id>
11372 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
11373 hostname.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011374 In order to be operational, DNS resolution requires that health check is
11375 enabled on the server. Actually, health checks triggers the DNS resolution.
11376 You must precise one 'resolvers' parameter on each server line where DNS
11377 resolution is required.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011378
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011379 Example:
11380
11381 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011382
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011383 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011384
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011385send-proxy
11386 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
11387 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
11388 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
11389 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010011390 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
11391 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
11392 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
11393 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
11394 fully be chained to another instance of haproxy listening with an
11395 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
11396 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
11397 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
11398 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
11399 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011400 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
11401 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010011402
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011403send-proxy-v2
11404 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
11405 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11406 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11407 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11408 whatever the upper layer protocol. This setting must not be used if the
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011409 server isn't aware of this version of the protocol. See also the
11410 "no-send-proxy-v2" option of this section and send-proxy" option of the
11411 "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011412
11413send-proxy-v2-ssl
11414 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11415 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11416 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11417 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11418 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11419 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
11420 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011421 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
11422 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011423
11424send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
11425 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
11426 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
11427 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
11428 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
11429 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
11430 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
11431 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
11432 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011433 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and the
11434 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040011435
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011436slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011437 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
11438 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
11439 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
11440 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
11441 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
11442 parameters :
11443
11444 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
11445 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
11446
11447 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
11448 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
11449 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
11450 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
11451
11452 The slowstart never applies when haproxy starts, otherwise it would cause
11453 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
11454 seen as failed.
11455
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020011456sni <expression>
11457 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
11458 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
11459 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
11460 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
11461 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense.
11462
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011463source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020011464source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011465source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011466 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
11467 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
11468 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
11469 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
11470
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020011471 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
11472 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
11473 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
11474 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
11475 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
11476 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
11477 server.
11478
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000011479 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
11480 specifying the source address without port(s).
11481
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011482ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020011483 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
11484 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
11485 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
11486 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
11487 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
11488 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011489 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
11490 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020011491
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020011492ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11493 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
11494 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
11495 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
11496
11497ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
11498 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
11499 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
11500 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
11501
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011502ssl-reuse
11503 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
11504 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11505 default value.
11506 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11507 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
11508
11509stick
11510 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
11511 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11512 default value.
11513 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11514 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020011515
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020011516tcp-ut <delay>
11517 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
11518 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows haproxy to
11519 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010011520 acknowledgement for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020011521 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
11522 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
11523 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
11524 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
11525 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
11526 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
11527 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
11528 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
11529 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
11530
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011531track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020011532 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
11533 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
11534 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
11535 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011536 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
11537
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011538tls-tickets
11539 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
11540 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
11541 default value.
11542 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
11543 "default-server" "no-tlsv-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011544
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011545verify [none|required]
11546 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010011547 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
11548 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file'
11549 and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. If 'ssl_server_verify' is not specified
11550 in global section, this is the default. On verify failure the handshake
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020011551 is aborted. It is critically important to verify server certificates when
11552 using SSL to connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to
11553 trivial man-in-the-middle attacks rendering SSL totally useless.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020011554
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070011555verifyhost <hostname>
11556 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
11557 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. When set, the
11558 hostnames in the subject and subjectAlternateNames of the certificate
11559 provided by the server are checked. If none of the hostnames in the
11560 certificate match the specified hostname, the handshake is aborted. The
11561 hostnames in the server-provided certificate may include wildcards.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010011562 See also "no-verifyhost" option.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070011563
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010011564weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011565 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
11566 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
11567 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020011568 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
11569 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
11570 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
11571 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
11572 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
11573 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011574
11575
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200115765.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
11577-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011578
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011579HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
11580using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
11581configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process' life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011582This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
11583can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
11584workload.
11585This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
11586resolution at run time.
11587Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
11588carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
11589
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011590Bear in mind that DNS resolution is triggered by health checks. This makes
11591health checks mandatory to allow DNS resolution.
11592
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011593
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200115945.3.1. Global overview
11595----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011596
11597As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
11598different steps of the process life:
11599
11600 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
11601 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
11602 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
11603
11604 2. at run time, when HAProxy gets prepared to run a health check on a server,
11605 it verifies if the current name resolution is still considered as valid.
11606 If not, it processes a new resolution, in parallel of the health check.
11607
11608A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
11609 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
11610 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
11611 resolution to know this new IP.
11612
11613A few things important to notice:
11614 - all the name servers are queried in the mean time. HAProxy will process the
11615 first valid response.
11616
11617 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
11618 servers return an error.
11619
11620
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200116215.3.2. The resolvers section
11622----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011623
11624This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
11625HAProxy.
11626There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can contain
11627many name servers.
11628
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011629When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
11630uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
11631is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
11632answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
11633
11634When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
11635used by HAProxy to decide what type of behavior to apply.
11636
11637Two types of behavior can be applied:
11638 1. stop DNS resolution
11639 2. replay the DNS query with a new query type
11640 In such case, the following types are applied in this exact order:
11641 1. ANY query type
11642 2. query type corresponding to family pointed by resolve-prefer
11643 server's parameter
11644 3. remaining family type
11645
11646HAProxy stops DNS resolution when the following errors occur:
11647 - invalid DNS response packet
11648 - wrong name in the query section of the response
11649 - NX domain
11650 - Query refused by server
11651 - CNAME not pointing to an IP address
11652
11653HAProxy tries a new query type when the following errors occur:
11654 - no Answer records in the response
11655 - DNS response truncated
11656 - Error in DNS response
11657 - No expected DNS records found in the response
11658 - name server timeout
11659
11660For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section:
11661 - first response is valid and is applied directly, second response is ignored
11662 - first response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
11663 applied;
11664 - first response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
11665 HAProxy replays the query with a new type;
11666 - first response is truncated and second one is a NX Domain, then HAProxy
11667 stops resolution.
11668
11669
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011670resolvers <resolvers id>
11671 Creates a new name server list labelled <resolvers id>
11672
11673A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
11674
11675nameserver <id> <ip>:<port>
11676 DNS server description:
11677 <id> : label of the server, should be unique
11678 <ip> : IP address of the server
11679 <port> : port where the DNS service actually runs
11680
11681hold <status> <period>
11682 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
11683 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010011684 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
11685 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011686 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
11687 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11688 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
11689
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010011690 Default value is 10s for "valid" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011691
11692 Note: since the name resolution is triggered by the health checks, a new
11693 resolution is triggered after <period> modulo the <inter> parameter of
11694 the healch check.
11695
11696resolve_retries <nb>
11697 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
11698 giving up.
11699 Default value: 3
11700
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020011701 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
11702 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
11703 type.
11704
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011705timeout <event> <time>
11706 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
11707 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
11708 events available are:
11709 - retry: time between two DNS queries, when no response have
11710 been received.
11711 Default value: 1s
11712 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
11713 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
11714
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020011715 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011716
11717 resolvers mydns
11718 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
11719 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
11720 resolve_retries 3
11721 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010011722 hold other 30s
11723 hold refused 30s
11724 hold nx 30s
11725 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020011726 hold valid 10s
11727
11728
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200117296. HTTP header manipulation
11730---------------------------
11731
11732In HTTP mode, it is possible to rewrite, add or delete some of the request and
11733response headers based on regular expressions. It is also possible to block a
11734request or a response if a particular header matches a regular expression,
11735which is enough to stop most elementary protocol attacks, and to protect
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011736against information leak from the internal network.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011737
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +010011738If HAProxy encounters an "Informational Response" (status code 1xx), it is able
11739to process all rsp* rules which can allow, deny, rewrite or delete a header,
11740but it will refuse to add a header to any such messages as this is not
11741HTTP-compliant. The reason for still processing headers in such responses is to
11742stop and/or fix any possible information leak which may happen, for instance
11743because another downstream equipment would unconditionally add a header, or if
11744a server name appears there. When such messages are seen, normal processing
11745still occurs on the next non-informational messages.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +020011746
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011747This section covers common usage of the following keywords, described in detail
11748in section 4.2 :
11749
11750 - reqadd <string>
11751 - reqallow <search>
11752 - reqiallow <search>
11753 - reqdel <search>
11754 - reqidel <search>
11755 - reqdeny <search>
11756 - reqideny <search>
11757 - reqpass <search>
11758 - reqipass <search>
11759 - reqrep <search> <replace>
11760 - reqirep <search> <replace>
11761 - reqtarpit <search>
11762 - reqitarpit <search>
11763 - rspadd <string>
11764 - rspdel <search>
11765 - rspidel <search>
11766 - rspdeny <search>
11767 - rspideny <search>
11768 - rsprep <search> <replace>
11769 - rspirep <search> <replace>
11770
11771With all these keywords, the same conventions are used. The <search> parameter
11772is a POSIX extended regular expression (regex) which supports grouping through
11773parenthesis (without the backslash). Spaces and other delimiters must be
11774prefixed with a backslash ('\') to avoid confusion with a field delimiter.
11775Other characters may be prefixed with a backslash to change their meaning :
11776
11777 \t for a tab
11778 \r for a carriage return (CR)
11779 \n for a new line (LF)
11780 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
11781 \# to mark a sharp and differentiate it from a comment
11782 \\ to use a backslash in a regex
11783 \\\\ to use a backslash in the text (*2 for regex, *2 for haproxy)
11784 \xXX to write the ASCII hex code XX as in the C language
11785
11786The <replace> parameter contains the string to be used to replace the largest
11787portion of text matching the regex. It can make use of the special characters
11788above, and can reference a substring which is delimited by parenthesis in the
11789regex, by writing a backslash ('\') immediately followed by one digit from 0 to
117909 indicating the group position (0 designating the entire line). This practice
11791is very common to users of the "sed" program.
11792
11793The <string> parameter represents the string which will systematically be added
11794after the last header line. It can also use special character sequences above.
11795
11796Notes related to these keywords :
11797---------------------------------
11798 - these keywords are not always convenient to allow/deny based on header
11799 contents. It is strongly recommended to use ACLs with the "block" keyword
11800 instead, resulting in far more flexible and manageable rules.
11801
11802 - lines are always considered as a whole. It is not possible to reference
11803 a header name only or a value only. This is important because of the way
11804 headers are written (notably the number of spaces after the colon).
11805
11806 - the first line is always considered as a header, which makes it possible to
11807 rewrite or filter HTTP requests URIs or response codes, but in turn makes
11808 it harder to distinguish between headers and request line. The regex prefix
11809 ^[^\ \t]*[\ \t] matches any HTTP method followed by a space, and the prefix
11810 ^[^ \t:]*: matches any header name followed by a colon.
11811
11812 - for performances reasons, the number of characters added to a request or to
11813 a response is limited at build time to values between 1 and 4 kB. This
11814 should normally be far more than enough for most usages. If it is too short
11815 on occasional usages, it is possible to gain some space by removing some
11816 useless headers before adding new ones.
11817
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011818 - keywords beginning with "reqi" and "rspi" are the same as their counterpart
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011819 without the 'i' letter except that they ignore case when matching patterns.
11820
11821 - when a request passes through a frontend then a backend, all req* rules
11822 from the frontend will be evaluated, then all req* rules from the backend
11823 will be evaluated. The reverse path is applied to responses.
11824
11825 - req* statements are applied after "block" statements, so that "block" is
11826 always the first one, but before "use_backend" in order to permit rewriting
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010011827 before switching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011828
11829
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200118307. Using ACLs and fetching samples
11831----------------------------------
11832
11833Haproxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
11834client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
11835The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
11836these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
11837but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
11838data called patterns.
11839
11840
118417.1. ACL basics
11842---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011843
11844The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
11845content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
11846from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
11847simple :
11848
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011849 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011850 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011851 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
11852 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011853
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011854The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
11855adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011856
11857In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
11858
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011859 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011860
11861This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
11862Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
11863and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011864an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
11865conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
11866as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
11867are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011868
11869ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
11870'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
11871which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
11872
11873There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
11874performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
11875
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011876The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
11877specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
11878this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011879methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
11880ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011881
11882Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
11883 - boolean
11884 - integer (signed or unsigned)
11885 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
11886 - string
11887 - data block
11888
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010011889Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
11890converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
11891would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
11892The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
11893which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
11894
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020011895Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
11896keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
11897fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
11898which are summarized in the table below :
11899
11900 +---------------------+-----------------+
11901 | Sample or converter | Default |
11902 | output type | matching method |
11903 +---------------------+-----------------+
11904 | boolean | bool |
11905 +---------------------+-----------------+
11906 | integer | int |
11907 +---------------------+-----------------+
11908 | ip | ip |
11909 +---------------------+-----------------+
11910 | string | str |
11911 +---------------------+-----------------+
11912 | binary | none, use "-m" |
11913 +---------------------+-----------------+
11914
11915Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
11916matching method, see below.
11917
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011918The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
11919 - boolean
11920 - integer or integer range
11921 - IP address / network
11922 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
11923 - regular expression
11924 - hex block
11925
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011926The following ACL flags are currently supported :
11927
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020011928 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
11929 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011930 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010011931 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010011932 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010011933 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020011934 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
11935
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011936The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
11937read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
11938if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
11939lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
11940will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
11941beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
11942a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, haproxy may load the
11943lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
11944exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
11945
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010011946The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
11947parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
11948ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
11949a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
11950check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
11951
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010011952The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
11953socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
11954file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
11955
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011956Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
11957loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
11958
11959 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
11960
11961In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
11962the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
11963case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
11964as well.
11965
11966The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
11967sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
11968do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
11969methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
11970is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
11971obvious matching method (eg: string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
11972followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
11973default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
11974that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
11975string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
11976
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010011977The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
11978By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
11979string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
11980resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
11981server is not reachable, the haproxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
11982waiting fir the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
11983flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
11984function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
11985
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011986There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
11987sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
11988be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011989
11990 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
11991 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011992 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
11993 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
11994 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
11995 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020011996
11997 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
11998 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020011999 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012000
12001 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012002 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012003
12004 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012005 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012006
12007 - "bin" : match the contents against an hexadecimal string representing a
12008 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
12009
12010 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
12011 binary or string samples.
12012
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012013 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
12014 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012015
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012016 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
12017 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
12018 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012019
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012020 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
12021 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012022
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012023 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
12024 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012025
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012026 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
12027 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012028
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012029 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
12030 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012031 This may be used with binary or string samples.
12032
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012033 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
12034 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
12035 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020012036
12037For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
12038request, it is possible to do :
12039
12040 acl jsess_present cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
12041
12042In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
12043buffer, one would use the following acl :
12044
12045 acl script_tag payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
12046
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012047On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
12048possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
12049
12050 acl script_tag payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
12051
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012052All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
12053criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
12054method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
12055to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
12056criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
12057the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012058
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012059If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012060the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
12061For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012062
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012063 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
12064 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
12065 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
12066 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012067
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020012068
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012069The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
12070types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
12071combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
12072brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
12073default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012074
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012075 +-------------------------------------------------+
12076 | Input sample type |
12077 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012078 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012079 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12080 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
12081 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012082 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012083 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012084 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012085 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012086 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012087 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012088 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012089 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020012090 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012091 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012092 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012093 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012094 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012095 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012096 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012097 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012098 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012099 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012100 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012101 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010012102 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012103 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
12104 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
12105 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012106
12107
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200121087.1.1. Matching booleans
12109------------------------
12110
12111In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
12112Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
12113When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
12114that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
12115
12116Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
12117return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
12118"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
12119
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012120
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200121217.1.2. Matching integers
12122------------------------
12123
12124Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
12125enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
12126to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
12127
12128Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
12129matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
12130lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012131
12132For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
12133unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
12134representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
12135
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012136As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
12137two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
12138instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
12139ranges and operators.
12140
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012141For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012142operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
12143Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
12144of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012145
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012146Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012147
12148 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
12149 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
12150 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
12151 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
12152 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
12153
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012154For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012155
12156 acl negative-length hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
12157
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012158This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
12159
12160 acl sslv3 req_ssl_ver 3:3.1
12161
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012162
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200121637.1.3. Matching strings
12164-----------------------
12165
12166String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
12167different forms :
12168
12169 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
12170 patterns ;
12171
12172 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
12173 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside ;
12174
12175 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
12176 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12177
12178 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
12179 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
12180
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010012181 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012182 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
12183 matches.
12184
12185 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
12186 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
12187 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012188
12189String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
12190exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
12191characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
12192string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
12193to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012194before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012195
12196
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200121977.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
12198---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012199
12200Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
12201they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
12202possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
12203passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
12204the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012205the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
12206match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012207
12208
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200122097.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
12210-------------------------------------
12211
12212It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
12213not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
12214a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
12215to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
12216digits may be used upper or lower case.
12217
12218Example :
12219 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
12220 acl hello payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
12221
12222
122237.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
12224---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012225
12226IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
12227netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
12228within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012229host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012230difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
12231at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
12232does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
12233parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012234
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020012235The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
12236abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
12237
12238 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12239 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
12240 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12241 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
12242 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
12243 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
12244 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
12245 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
12246
12247Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
12248192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
12249
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020012250IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
12251Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
12252trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
12253IPv6 patterns.
12254
12255HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
12256following situations :
12257 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
12258 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
12259 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
12260 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
12261 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
12262 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
12263 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
12264 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
12265 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
12266 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
12267
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012268
122697.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
12270----------------------------------
12271
12272Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
12273combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
12274
12275 - AND (implicit)
12276 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
12277 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012278
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012279A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020012280
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012281 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012282
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012283Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
12284indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020012285
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012286For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
12287"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
12288requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
12289is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
12290
12291 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012292 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
12293 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
12294 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012295
12296To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
12297and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
12298
12299 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
12300 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
12301 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
12302 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
12303
12304 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static urls
12305 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
12306 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
12307 use_backend www if host_www
12308
12309It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
12310expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
12311be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
12312the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
12313
12314 The following rule :
12315
12316 acl missing_cl hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012317 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012318
12319 Can also be written that way :
12320
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012321 http-request deny if METH_POST { hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012322
12323It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
12324to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
12325simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
12326sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
12327good use is the following :
12328
12329 With named ACLs :
12330
12331 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
12332 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
12333 monitor fail if site_dead
12334
12335 With anonymous ACLs :
12336
12337 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
12338
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030012339See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
12340keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012341
12342
123437.3. Fetching samples
12344---------------------
12345
12346Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
12347against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
12348sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
12349ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
12350of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
12351available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
12352
12353This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
12354Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
12355compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
12356deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
12357
12358The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
12359matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
12360method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
12361indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
12362
12363As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
12364when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
12365mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
12366the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
12367ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
12368
12369Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
12370multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
12371when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
12372incorrect argument (eg: an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
12373are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
12374is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
12375all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
12376
12377Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
12378 - name
12379 - name(arg1)
12380 - name(arg1,arg2)
12381
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012382
123837.3.1. Converters
12384-----------------
12385
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010012386Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
12387of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
12388is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
12389was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
12390has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (acls, log-format,
12391unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
12392
12393These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
12394sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
12395the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
12396support some arguments (eg: a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012397
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012398A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
12399support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
12400supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
12401(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
12402bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
12403
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012404The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012405
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001240651d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
12407 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
12408 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
12409 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
12410 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
12411 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
12412
12413 Example :
12414 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
12415 # containg values for the three properties requested by using the
12416 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
12417 frontend http-in
12418 bind *:8081
12419 default_backend servers
12420 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
12421 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
12422
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012423add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012424 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012425 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012426 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
12427 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012428 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012429 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12430 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12431 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12432 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12433 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012434 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012435
12436and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012437 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012438 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012439 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
12440 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012441 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012442 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12443 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12444 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12445 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12446 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012447 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012448
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020012449b64dec
12450 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
12451 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
12452
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020012453base64
12454 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
12455 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg:
12456 an SSL ID can be copied in a header).
12457
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012458bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012459 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012460 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
12461 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
12462 presence of a flag).
12463
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010012464bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
12465 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
12466 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012467 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010012468
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012469cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012470 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
12471 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012472
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012473crc32([<avalanche>])
12474 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
12475 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12476 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12477 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12478 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12479 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
12480 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
12481 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
12482 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
12483 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
12484 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6" and the "hash-type" directive.
12485
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010012486da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012487 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
12488 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
12489 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
12490 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000012491 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the haproxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012492 configuration language.
12493
12494 Example:
12495 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020012496 bind *:8881
12497 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000012498 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020012499
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020012500debug
12501 This converter is used as debug tool. It dumps on screen the content and the
12502 type of the input sample. The sample is returned as is on its output. This
12503 converter only exists when haproxy was built with debugging enabled.
12504
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012505div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012506 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
12507 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012508 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012509 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
12510 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012511 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012512 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12513 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12514 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12515 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12516 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012517 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012518
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012519djb2([<avalanche>])
12520 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
12521 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12522 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12523 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12524 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12525 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12526 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012527 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6" and the
12528 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012529
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012530even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012531 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012532 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
12533
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010012534field(<index>,<delimiters>)
12535 Extracts the substring at the given index considering given delimiters from
12536 an input string. Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted
12537 list of chars.
12538
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012539hex
12540 Converts a binary input sample to an hex string containing two hex digits per
12541 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
12542 in a way that can be reliably transferred (eg: an SSL ID can be copied in a
12543 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010012544
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012545http_date([<offset>])
12546 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12547 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
12548 an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added to
12549 the date before the conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to
12550 emit Date header fields, Expires values in responses when combined with a
12551 positive offset, or Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012552
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012553in_table(<table>)
12554 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12555 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
12556 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
12557 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (eg: whether
12558 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
12559
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012560ipmask(<mask>)
12561 Apply a mask to an IPv4 address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
12562 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
12563 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask can be passed in
12564 dotted form (eg: 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (eg: 24).
12565
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012566json([<input-code>])
12567 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII ouput string ready to use as a
12568 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020012569 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012570 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
12571 of errors:
12572 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
12573 bytes, ...)
12574 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
12575 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
12576
12577 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
12578 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
12579 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
12580 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
12581 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
12582 are :
12583 - "ascii" : never fails ;
12584 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors ;
12585 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors ;
12586 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
12587 error ;
12588 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
12589 characters corresponding to the other errors.
12590
12591 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
12592 logging to servers which consume JSON-formated traffic logs.
12593
12594 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012595 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020012596 capture request header user-agent len 150
12597 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020012598
12599 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
12600 GET / HTTP/1.0
12601 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
12602
12603 Output log:
12604 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
12605
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012606language(<value>[,<default>])
12607 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
12608 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
12609 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
12610 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
12611 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
12612 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
12613 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
12614 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
12615 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
12616 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
12617 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
12618 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012619
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012620 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012621
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012622 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
12623 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012624
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012625 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
12626 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
12627 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
12628 use_backend spanish if es
12629 use_backend french if fr
12630 use_backend english if en
12631 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020012632
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020012633lower
12634 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
12635 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
12636 type. The result is of type string.
12637
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020012638ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
12639 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
12640 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
12641 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
12642 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
12643 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
12644 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
12645
12646 Example :
12647
12648 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
12649 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
12650 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
12651
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012652map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12653map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12654map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
12655 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
12656 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
12657 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
12658 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
12659 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
12660 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
12661 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
12662 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012663
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012664 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
12665 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
12666 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012667
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010012668 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012669 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012670
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012671 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
12672 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12673 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
12674 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020012675 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
12676 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012677 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
12678 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12679 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
12680 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12681 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
12682 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12683 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
12684 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080012685 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
12686 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12687 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012688 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12689 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
12690 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
12691 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
12692 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012693
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010012694 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
12695 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
12696 the corresponding match text.
12697
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012698 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
12699 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
12700 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
12701 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
12702 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010012703
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020012704 Example :
12705
12706 # this is a comment and is ignored
12707 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
12708 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
12709 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
12710 | | | `---------- value
12711 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
12712 | `---------------------------- key
12713 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
12714
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012715mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012716 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
12717 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012718 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012719 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012720 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012721 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12722 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12723 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12724 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12725 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012726 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012727
12728mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012729 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020012730 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
12731 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012732 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012733 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012734 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012735 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12736 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12737 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12738 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12739 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012740 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012741
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010012742nbsrv
12743 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
12744 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
12745 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
12746 map lookup.
12747
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012748neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012749 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
12750 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
12751 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
12752 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012753
12754not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012755 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012756 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
12757 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (eg: verify the
12758 absence of a flag).
12759
12760odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012761 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012762 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
12763
12764or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012765 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012766 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012767 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
12768 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012769 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012770 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12771 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
12772 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
12773 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
12774 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012775 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012776
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010012777regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010012778 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
12779 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
12780 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
12781 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
12782 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
12783 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
12784 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
12785 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
12786 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
12787 It is important to note that due to the current limitations of the
Baptiste Assmann66025d82016-03-06 23:36:48 +010012788 configuration parser, some characters such as closing parenthesis, closing
12789 square brackets or comma are not possible to use in the arguments. The first
12790 use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence of
12791 characters with other ones.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010012792
12793 Example :
12794
12795 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
12796 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
12797 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
12798 http-request set-header x-path %[hdr(x-path),regsub(/+,/,g)]
12799
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012800capture-req(<id>)
12801 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
12802 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
12803
12804 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020012805 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
12806 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012807
12808capture-res(<id>)
12809 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
12810 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
12811
12812 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020012813 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
12814 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020012815
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012816sdbm([<avalanche>])
12817 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
12818 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
12819 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
12820 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
12821 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
12822 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
12823 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010012824 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6" and the
12825 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020012826
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012827set-var(<var name>)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012828 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output as
12829 is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of the
12830 variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012831 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012832 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12833 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012834 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012835 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12836 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012837 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012838 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012839
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012840sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020012841 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
12842 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012843 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012844 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12845 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012846 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012847 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12848 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012849 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012850 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
12851 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020012852 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012853 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010012854
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012855table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
12856 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12857 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12858 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
12859 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
12860 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
12861 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
12862
12863
12864table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
12865 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12866 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12867 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
12868 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
12869 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
12870 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
12871
12872table_conn_cnt(<table>)
12873 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12874 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12875 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
12876 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
12877 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12878
12879table_conn_cur(<table>)
12880 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12881 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12882 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
12883 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
12884 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
12885
12886table_conn_rate(<table>)
12887 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12888 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12889 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
12890 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
12891 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
12892
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012893table_gpt0(<table>)
12894 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12895 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
12896 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
12897 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
12898 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
12899
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020012900table_gpc0(<table>)
12901 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12902 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12903 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
12904 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
12905 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
12906
12907table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
12908 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12909 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12910 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
12911 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
12912 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
12913 sample fetch keyword.
12914
12915table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
12916 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12917 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12918 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
12919 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
12920 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12921
12922table_http_err_rate(<table>)
12923 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12924 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12925 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
12926 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
12927 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
12928 keyword.
12929
12930table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
12931 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12932 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12933 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of HTTP
12934 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
12935 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
12936
12937table_http_req_rate(<table>)
12938 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12939 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12940 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
12941 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
12942 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
12943 keyword.
12944
12945table_kbytes_in(<table>)
12946 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12947 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12948 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of client-
12949 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
12950 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
12951 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
12952 keyword.
12953
12954table_kbytes_out(<table>)
12955 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12956 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12957 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of server-
12958 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
12959 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
12960 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
12961 keyword.
12962
12963table_server_id(<table>)
12964 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12965 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12966 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
12967 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
12968 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
12969 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
12970
12971table_sess_cnt(<table>)
12972 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12973 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12974 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulated amount of incoming
12975 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
12976 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
12977 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
12978 keyword.
12979
12980table_sess_rate(<table>)
12981 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12982 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12983 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
12984 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
12985 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
12986 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
12987 keyword.
12988
12989table_trackers(<table>)
12990 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
12991 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
12992 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
12993 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
12994 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
12995 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
12996 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
12997 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
12998 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
12999 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
13000
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020013001upper
13002 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
13003 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
13004 type. The result is of type string.
13005
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020013006url_dec
13007 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded
13008 version as output. The input and the output are of type string.
13009
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010013010unset-var(<var name>)
13011 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
13012 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
13013 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
13014 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13015 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
13016 response),
13017 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13018 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
13019 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
13020 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
13021
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020013022utime(<format>[,<offset>])
13023 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
13024 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
13025 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
13026 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
13027 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
13028 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
13029
13030 Example :
13031
13032 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
13033 # Eg: 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
13034 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
13035
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010013036word(<index>,<delimiters>)
13037 Extracts the nth word considering given delimiters from an input string.
13038 Indexes start at 1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
13039
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013040wt6([<avalanche>])
13041 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
13042 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
13043 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
13044 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
13045 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
13046 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
13047 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010013048 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", and the
13049 "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020013050
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013051xor(<value>)
13052 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013053 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013054 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013055 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013056 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013057 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13058 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013059 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013060 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13061 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020013062 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013063 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010013064
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010013065xxh32([<seed>])
13066 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
13067 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13068 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13069 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13070 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
13071 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
13072 as cryptographically secure.
13073
13074xxh64([<seed>])
13075 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
13076 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
13077 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
13078 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
13079 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
13080 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
13081 as cryptographically secure.
13082
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013083
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200130847.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013085--------------------------------------------
13086
13087A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
13088not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
13089"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
13090The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
13091
13092always_false : boolean
13093 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
13094 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
13095
13096always_true : boolean
13097 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
13098 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
13099
13100avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013101 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013102 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
13103 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
13104 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
13105 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
13106 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
13107 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
13108 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
13109 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
13110 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
13111 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
13112 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
13113 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
13114 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010013115
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013116be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013117 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
13118 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
13119 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
13120 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
13121 See also the "fe_conn", "queue" and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020013122
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013123be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
13124 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13125 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
13126 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
13127 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent sucking of an
13128 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
13129 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013130
13131 Example :
13132 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
13133 backend dynamic
13134 mode http
13135 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
13136 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013137
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013138bin(<hexa>) : bin
13139 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
13140 of the string.
13141
13142bool(<bool>) : bool
13143 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
13144 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
13145
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013146connslots([<backend>]) : integer
13147 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013148 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013149 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
13150 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050013151
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013152 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013153 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013154 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
13155
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013156 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
13157 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013158
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013159 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013160 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013161 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013162 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
13163 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013164 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013165 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013166
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013167 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
13168 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013169 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020013170 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080013171
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020013172date([<offset>]) : integer
13173 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
13174 If an offset value is specified, then it is a number of seconds that is added
13175 to the current date before returning the value. This is particularly useful
13176 to compute relative dates, as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020013177 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
13178
13179 Example :
13180
13181 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
13182 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020013183
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020013184env(<name>) : string
13185 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
13186 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
13187 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
13188 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
13189 certain way.
13190
13191 Examples :
13192 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
13193 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
13194
13195 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
13196 http-request deny if !{ cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
13197
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013198fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
13199 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013200 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
13201 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013202 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
13203 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
13204 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
13205 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
13206 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020013207
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020013208fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
13209 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
13210 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
13211 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
13212
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013213fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
13214 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13215 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
13216 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
13217 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
13218 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
13219 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
13220 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
13221 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013222
13223 Example :
13224 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
13225 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
13226 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
13227 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
13228 frontend mail
13229 bind :25
13230 mode tcp
13231 maxconn 100
13232 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
13233 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
13234 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
13235 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013236
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010013237hostname : string
13238 Returns the system hostname.
13239
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020013240int(<integer>) : signed integer
13241 Returns a signed integer.
13242
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013243ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
13244 Returns an ipv4.
13245
13246ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
13247 Returns an ipv6.
13248
13249meth(<method>) : method
13250 Returns a method.
13251
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013252nbproc : integer
13253 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
13254 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
13255 and debugging purposes.
13256
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013257nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
13258 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
13259 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
13260 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013261 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
13262 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
13263 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013264
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013265proc : integer
13266 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
13267 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
13268 debugging purposes.
13269
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013270queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013271 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
13272 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
13273 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013274 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
13275 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
13276 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
13277 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
13278 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
13279
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010013280rand([<range>]) : integer
13281 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
13282 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
13283 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
13284 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
13285 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
13286
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013287srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13288 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
13289 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
13290 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
13291 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
13292 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
13293 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn" and "queue" fetch
13294 methods.
13295
13296srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
13297 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
13298 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
13299 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
13300 an external status reported via a health check (eg: a geographical site's
13301 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
13302 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
13303 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
13304
13305srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
13306 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
13307 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013308 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013309 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
13310 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
13311 rate, or to limit abuse of service (eg. prevent latent requests from
13312 overloading servers).
13313
13314 Example :
13315 # Redirect to a separate back
13316 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
13317 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
13318 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
13319
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010013320stopping : boolean
13321 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
13322 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
13323 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
13324
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020013325str(<string>) : string
13326 Returns a string.
13327
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013328table_avl([<table>]) : integer
13329 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
13330 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
13331
13332table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13333 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
13334 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
13335 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
13336
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013337var(<var-name>) : undefined
13338 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013339 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
13340 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010013341 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013342 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
13343 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013344 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010013345 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
13346 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013347 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010013348 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020013349
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200133507.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013351----------------------------------
13352
13353The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in haproxy is
13354closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
13355methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
13356sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
13357TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013358the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
13359counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
13360"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix, or it can be specified as the first integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013361argument when using the "sc_" prefix. An optional table may be specified with
13362the "sc*" form, in which case the currently tracked key will be looked up into
13363this alternate table instead of the table currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013364
13365be_id : integer
13366 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
13367 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
13368
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010013369be_name : string
13370 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
13371 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request.
13372
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013373dst : ip
13374 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
13375 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
13376 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
13377 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
13378 RFC 4291.
13379
13380dst_conn : integer
13381 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
13382 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
13383 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
13384 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
13385 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
13386 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
13387 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
13388 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013389
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020013390dst_is_local : boolean
13391 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
13392 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
13393 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
13394 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
13395 targetting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
13396 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
13397 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
13398 it only once per connection.
13399
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013400dst_port : integer
13401 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
13402 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
13403 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
13404 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
13405 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
13406 an HTTP header.
13407
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010013408fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
13409 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
13410 header.
13411
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020013412fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
13413 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
13414 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
13415 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
13416 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
13417 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
13418 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13419
13420fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
13421 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
13422 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
13423 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
13424 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
13425 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
13426 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13427
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070013428fc_unacked(<unit>) : integer
13429 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
13430 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
13431 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
13432 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13433
13434fc_sacked(<unit>) : integer
13435 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
13436 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
13437 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
13438 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13439
13440fc_retrans(<unit>) : integer
13441 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
13442 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13443 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13444 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13445
13446fc_fackets(<unit>) : integer
13447 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
13448 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13449 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13450 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13451
13452fc_lost(<unit>) : integer
13453 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
13454 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13455 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13456 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13457
13458fc_reordering(<unit>) : integer
13459 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
13460 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
13461 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
13462 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
13463
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013464fe_id : integer
13465 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010013466 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013467 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
13468
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010013469fe_name : string
13470 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
13471 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
13472 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
13473
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013474sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013475sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13476sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13477sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013478 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
13479 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
13480 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
13481
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013482sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013483sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13484sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13485sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013486 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
13487 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
13488 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
13489
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013490sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013491sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13492sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13493sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013494 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
13495 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013496 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
13497 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
13498 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013499
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013500 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013501 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
13502 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013503 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
13504 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
13505 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013506 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
13507 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13508
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013509sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013510sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13511sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13512sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013513 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections from currently tracked
13514 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
13515
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013516sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013517sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
13518sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
13519sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013520 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
13521 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
13522 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
13523
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013524sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013525sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13526sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13527sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013528 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
13529 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
13530 See also src_conn_rate.
13531
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013532sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013533sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13534sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13535sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013536 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013537 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013538
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013539sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
13540sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13541sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13542sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13543 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
13544 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
13545
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013546sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013547sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
13548sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
13549sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013550 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
13551 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
13552 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013553 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
13554 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
13555 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013556
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013557sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013558sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13559sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13560sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013561 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
13562 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
13563 See also src_http_err_cnt.
13564
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013565sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013566sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13567sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13568sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013569 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
13570 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
13571 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
13572 src_http_err_rate.
13573
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013574sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013575sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13576sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13577sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013578 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
13579 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
13580 src_http_req_cnt.
13581
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013582sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013583sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13584sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13585sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013586 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
13587 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
13588 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
13589 src_http_req_rate.
13590
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013591sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013592sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13593sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13594sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013595 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013596 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
13597 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
13598 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
13599 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013600
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013601 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013602 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
13603 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013604 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13605
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013606sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013607sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
13608sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
13609sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013610 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
13611 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
13612 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013613
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013614sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013615sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
13616sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
13617sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013618 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
13619 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
13620 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013621
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013622sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013623sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13624sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13625sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013626 Returns the cumulated number of incoming connections that were transformed
13627 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
13628 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
13629 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013630 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013631 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
13632
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013633sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013634sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13635sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13636sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013637 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
13638 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
13639 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
13640 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
13641 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013642 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013643
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013644sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013645sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
13646sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
13647sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020013648 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
13649 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
13650 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
13651
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020013652sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020013653sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
13654sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
13655sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013656 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
13657 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013658 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013659 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
13660 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013661 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
13662 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
13663 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010013664
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013665so_id : integer
13666 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
13667 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
13668 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013669
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013670src : ip
13671 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
13672 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
13673 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
13674 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013675 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
13676 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
13677 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
13678 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010013679
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010013680 Example:
13681 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
13682 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
13683
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013684src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
13685 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
13686 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
13687 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013688 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013689
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013690src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
13691 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
13692 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013693 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013694 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013695
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013696src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13697 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
13698 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13699 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
13700 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
13701 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
13702 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013703
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013704 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013705 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
13706 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
13707 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
13708 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013709 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020013710 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
13711 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
13712
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013713src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013714 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013715 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013716 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013717 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013718
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013719src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013720 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013721 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
13722 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013723 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013724
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013725src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
13726 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
13727 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13728 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013729 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013730
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013731src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013732 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013733 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013734 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013735 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013736
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020013737src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
13738 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
13739 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
13740 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
13741 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
13742
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013743src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013744 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013745 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013746 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
13747 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013748 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
13749 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
13750 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020013751
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013752src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13753 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
13754 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013755 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013756 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013757 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013758
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013759src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
13760 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
13761 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13762 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
13763 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013764 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013765
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013766src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13767 Returns the cumulated number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
13768 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
13769 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013770 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013771
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013772src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
13773 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
13774 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
13775 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013776 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013777 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013778
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013779src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
13780 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
13781 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13782 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020013783 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013784 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
13785 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013786
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013787 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013788 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010013789 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020013790 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013791
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020013792src_is_local : boolean
13793 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
13794 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
13795 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
13796 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
13797 client comes from (eg: require auth or https for remote machines). Please
13798 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
13799 once per connection.
13800
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013801src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013802 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
13803 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
13804 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
13805 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
13806 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013807
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013808src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020013809 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
13810 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13811 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
13812 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
13813 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013814
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013815src_port : integer
13816 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
13817 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
13818 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
13819 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010013820
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013821src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13822 Returns the cumulated number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013823 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
13824 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
13825 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013826 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013827
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013828src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
13829 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
13830 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
13831 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
13832 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020013833 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013834
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013835src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
13836 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
13837 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
13838 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
13839 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
13840 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
13841 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
13842 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
13843 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013844
13845 Example :
13846 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
13847 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
13848 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
13849 listen ssh
13850 bind :22
13851 mode tcp
13852 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020013853 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013854 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020013855 server local 127.0.0.1:22
13856
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013857srv_id : integer
13858 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
13859 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
13860 debugging.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020013861
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200138627.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013863----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020013864
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013865The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in haproxy is
13866closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
13867when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
13868usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013869future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020013870
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001387151d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
13872 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
13873 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
13874 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
13875 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
13876 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
13877
13878 Example :
13879 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
13880 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
13881 # the request.
13882 frontend http-in
13883 bind *:8081
13884 default_backend servers
13885 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
13886 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
13887
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013888ssl_bc : boolean
13889 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
13890 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
13891 other a server with the "ssl" option.
13892
13893ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
13894 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
13895 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13896
13897ssl_bc_cipher : string
13898 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
13899 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13900
13901ssl_bc_protocol : string
13902 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
13903 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13904
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013905ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013906 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020013907 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
13908 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020013909
13910ssl_bc_session_id : binary
13911 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
13912 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
13913 if session was reused or not.
13914
13915ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
13916 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
13917 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
13918
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013919ssl_c_ca_err : integer
13920 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13921 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
13922 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
13923 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
13924 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020013925
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013926ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
13927 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13928 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
13929 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
13930 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010013931
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010013932ssl_c_der : binary
13933 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
13934 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13935 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
13936
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013937ssl_c_err : integer
13938 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13939 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
13940 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
13941 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
13942 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013943
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013944ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13945 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13946 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
13947 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13948 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13949 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13950 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13951 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13952 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013953
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013954ssl_c_key_alg : string
13955 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
13956 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13957 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020013958
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013959ssl_c_notafter : string
13960 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
13961 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13962 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020013963
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013964ssl_c_notbefore : string
13965 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
13966 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
13967 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010013968
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013969ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
13970 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
13971 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
13972 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
13973 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
13974 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
13975 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
13976 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
13977 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010013978
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013979ssl_c_serial : binary
13980 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
13981 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
13982 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013983
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013984ssl_c_sha1 : binary
13985 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
13986 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
13987 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020013988 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
13989 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
13990
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030013991 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020013992 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020013993
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013994ssl_c_sig_alg : string
13995 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
13996 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
13997 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020013998
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020013999ssl_c_used : boolean
14000 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
14001 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020014002
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014003ssl_c_verify : integer
14004 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
14005 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
14006 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
14007 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020014008
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014009ssl_c_version : integer
14010 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
14011 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020014012
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010014013ssl_f_der : binary
14014 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
14015 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14016 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
14017
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014018ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14019 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14020 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
14021 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14022 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014023 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014024 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14025 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14026 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014027
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014028ssl_f_key_alg : string
14029 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
14030 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
14031 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020014032
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014033ssl_f_notafter : string
14034 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
14035 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14036 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014037
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014038ssl_f_notbefore : string
14039 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
14040 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
14041 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014042
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014043ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>]]) : string
14044 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
14045 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
14046 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
14047 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
14048 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
14049 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
14050 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
14051 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020014052
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014053ssl_f_serial : binary
14054 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
14055 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
14056 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020014057
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020014058ssl_f_sha1 : binary
14059 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
14060 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
14061 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
14062
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014063ssl_f_sig_alg : string
14064 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
14065 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
14066 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020014067
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014068ssl_f_version : integer
14069 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
14070 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14071
14072ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014073 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
14074 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
14075 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
14076
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014077 Example :
14078 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
14079 listen http-https
14080 bind :80
14081 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
14082 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
14083
14084ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
14085 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
14086 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
14087
14088ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014089 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014090 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
14091 haproxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
14092 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
14093 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
14094 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
14095 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
14096 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
14097 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
14098
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014099ssl_fc_cipher : string
14100 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
14101 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020014102
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014103ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
14104 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
14105 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014106 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014107
14108ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
14109 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
14110 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014111 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014112
14113ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
14114 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
14115 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
14116 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
14117 avaible with OpenSSL > 1.0.2 compiled with the option enable-ssl-trace.
14118 If the function is not enabled, this sample-fetch returns the hash
14119 like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
14120
14121ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
14122 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
14123 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010014124 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010014125
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014126ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014127 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
14128 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010014129 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
14130 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
14131 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
14132 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020014133
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014134ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
14135 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020014136 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
14137 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
14138 that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
14139 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014140
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020014141ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020014142 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
14143 SSL session cache or TLS tickets.
14144
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014145ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014146 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014147 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by haproxy. The result
14148 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
14149 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
14150 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
14151 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
14152 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
14153 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020014154
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014155ssl_fc_protocol : string
14156 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
14157 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014158
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014159ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040014160 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020014161 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
14162 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040014163
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014164ssl_fc_session_id : binary
14165 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
14166 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
14167 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
14168 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020014169
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014170ssl_fc_sni : string
14171 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
14172 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
14173 deciphered by haproxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
14174 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
14175 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
14176
14177 This fetch is different from "req_ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
14178 connection being deciphered by haproxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
14179 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020014180 requires that the SSL library is build with support for TLS extensions
14181 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014182
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014183 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014184 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
14185 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020014186
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014187ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
14188 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
14189 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014190
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014191
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200141927.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014193------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020014194
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014195Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
14196sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
14197only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
14198For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
14199be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
14200can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
14201sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
14202for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
14203content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020014204
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014205payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
14206 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (eg:
14207 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
14208 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014209
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014210payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
14211 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
14212 (eg: "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
14213 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014214
Thierry FOURNIERd7d88812017-04-19 15:15:14 +020014215req.hdrs : string
14216 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
14217 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
14218 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
14219 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
14220
Thierry FOURNIER5617dce2017-04-09 05:38:19 +020014221req.hdrs_bin : binary
14222 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
14223 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
14224 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
14225 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
14226 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
14227 names and values (length of 0 for both).
14228
14229 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
14230
14231 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
14232 str: <int:length><bytes>
14233
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014234req.len : integer
14235req_len : integer (deprecated)
14236 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
14237 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
14238 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
14239 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
14240 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
14241 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
14242 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
14243 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014244
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014245req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
14246 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020014247 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
14248 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
14249 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
14250 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014251
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014252 ACL alternatives :
14253 payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014254
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014255req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
14256 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
14257 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
14258 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
14259 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014260
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014261 ACL alternatives :
14262 payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014263
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014264 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014265
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014266req.proto_http : boolean
14267req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
14268 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
14269 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
14270 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
14271 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
14272 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
14273 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
14274 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014275
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014276 Example:
14277 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
14278 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
14279 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020014280 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020014281
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014282req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
14283rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14284 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
14285 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
14286 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
14287 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
14288 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
14289 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
14290 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014291
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014292 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
14293 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
14294 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
14295 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
14296 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
14297 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014298
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014299 ACL derivatives :
14300 req_rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014301
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014302 Example :
14303 listen tse-farm
14304 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
14305 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
14306 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
14307 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
14308 # apply RDP cookie persistence
14309 persist rdp-cookie
14310 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
14311 # This is only useful makes sense if
14312 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
14313 stick-table type string size 204800
14314 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
14315 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
14316 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014317
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014318 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
14319 "req_rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014320
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014321req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
14322rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
14323 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
14324 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
14325 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
14326 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014327
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014328 ACL derivatives :
14329 req_rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014330
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020014331req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
14332 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
14333 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020014334 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
14335 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
14336 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
14337 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
14338 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020014339
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014340req.ssl_hello_type : integer
14341req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
14342 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
14343 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
14344 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
14345 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
14346 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
14347 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
14348 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014349
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014350req.ssl_sni : string
14351req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
14352 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
14353 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
14354 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
14355 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
14356 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
14357 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. SNI normally contains the
14358 name of the host the client tries to connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is
14359 useful for allowing or denying access to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used
14360 by the client. This test was designed to be used with TCP request content
14361 inspection. If content switching is needed, it is recommended to first wait
14362 for a complete client hello (type 1), like in the example below. See also
14363 "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014364
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014365 ACL derivatives :
14366 req_ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014367
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014368 Examples :
14369 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
14370 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
14371 tcp-request content accept if { req_ssl_hello_type 1 }
14372 use_backend bk_allow if { req_ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
14373 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020014374
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053014375req.ssl_st_ext : integer
14376 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
14377 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
14378 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
14379 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
14380 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
14381 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
14382 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
14383 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
14384 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
14385
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014386req.ssl_ver : integer
14387req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
14388 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
14389 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
14390 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
14391 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
14392 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
14393 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
14394 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
14395 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (eg: 3.1). This
14396 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014397
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014398 ACL derivatives :
14399 req_ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014400
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020014401res.len : integer
14402 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
14403 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
14404 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
14405 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
14406 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
14407 that data to come in and return false only when haproxy is certain that no
14408 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
14409 content inspection.
14410
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014411res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
14412 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020014413 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
14414 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
14415 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
14416 any location.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014417
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014418res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
14419 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
14420 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
14421 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
14422 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014423
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014424 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014425
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020014426res.ssl_hello_type : integer
14427rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
14428 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
14429 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
14430 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
14431 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
14432 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
14433 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
14434 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
14435
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014436wait_end : boolean
14437 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
14438 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
14439 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
14440 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
14441 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
14442 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
14443 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
14444 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014445
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014446 Examples :
14447 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
14448 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
14449 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014450
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014451 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
14452 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
14453 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
14454 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
14455 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
14456 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
14457 tcp-request content reject
14458
14459
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200144607.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014461--------------------------------------
14462
14463It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
14464This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
14465data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
14466its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
14467HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
14468content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
14469to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
14470more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
14471response are indexed.
14472
14473base : string
14474 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
14475 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
14476 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
14477 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
14478 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
14479 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
14480 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
14481 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
14482
14483 ACL derivatives :
14484 base : exact string match
14485 base_beg : prefix match
14486 base_dir : subdir match
14487 base_dom : domain match
14488 base_end : suffix match
14489 base_len : length match
14490 base_reg : regex match
14491 base_sub : substring match
14492
14493base32 : integer
14494 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
14495 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
14496 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020014497 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
14498 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
14499 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014500
14501base32+src : binary
14502 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
14503 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
14504 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
14505 per-URL counters.
14506
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010014507capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
14508 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
14509 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
14510 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
14511
14512capture.req.method : string
14513 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
14514 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
14515 because it's allocated.
14516
14517capture.req.uri : string
14518 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
14519 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
14520 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
14521 allocated.
14522
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020014523capture.req.ver : string
14524 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
14525 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
14526 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
14527
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010014528capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
14529 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
14530 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
14531 The first entry is an index of 0.
14532 See also: "capture response header"
14533
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020014534capture.res.ver : string
14535 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
14536 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
14537 persistent flag.
14538
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020014539req.body : binary
14540 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It
14541 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
14542 "option http-buffer-request". In case of chunked-encoded body, currently only
14543 the first chunk is analyzed.
14544
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020014545req.body_param([<name>) : string
14546 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
14547 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
14548 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
14549 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
14550 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
14551 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
14552 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
14553 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
14554 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
14555 given.
14556
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020014557req.body_len : integer
14558 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
14559 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
14560 requires that the request body has been buffered made available using
14561 "option http-buffer-request".
14562
14563req.body_size : integer
14564 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
14565 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the first
14566 chunk in case of chunked encoding. In order to parse the chunks, it requires
14567 that the request body has been buffered made available using
14568 "option http-buffer-request".
14569
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014570req.cook([<name>]) : string
14571cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14572 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14573 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
14574 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
14575 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
14576 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
14577 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
14578 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
14579 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
14580
14581 ACL derivatives :
14582 cook([<name>]) : exact string match
14583 cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
14584 cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
14585 cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
14586 cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
14587 cook_len([<name>]) : length match
14588 cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
14589 cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014590
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014591req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14592cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14593 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
14594 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014595
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014596req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
14597cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14598 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14599 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
14600 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
14601 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014602
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014603cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14604 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
14605 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
14606 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
14607 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020014608 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014609 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
14610 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
14611 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
14612 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014613
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014614hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14615 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
14616 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
14617 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
14618 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014619 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014620
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014621req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
14622 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
14623 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
14624 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14625 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14626 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14627 with -1 being the last one. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas
14628 present in the value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is
14629 sometimes useful with headers such as User-Agent.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014630
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014631req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14632 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
14633 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14634 not specified. Contrary to its req.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
14635 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014636
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014637req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14638 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request. When
14639 used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is found.
14640 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14641 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14642 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14643 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header
14644 once converted to IP, associated with an IP stick-table. The function
14645 considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +000014646 are desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC7231 to know
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014647 how certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
14648 insensitive (eg: Connection).
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014649
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014650 ACL derivatives :
14651 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
14652 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
14653 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
14654 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
14655 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
14656 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
14657 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
14658 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
14659
14660req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14661hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
14662 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
14663 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
14664 <name> is not specified. It is important to remember that one header line may
14665 count as several headers if it has several values. The function considers any
14666 comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If full-line headers are desired
14667 instead, req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead. With ACLs, it can be used to
14668 detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific header, as well as to block
14669 request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests which contain more than one
14670 of certain headers. See "req.hdr" for more information on header matching.
14671
14672req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
14673hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
14674 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
14675 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
14676 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
14677 of every header is checked. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
14678 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
14679 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
14680 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. A typical use
14681 is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
14682
14683req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
14684hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
14685 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
14686 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
14687 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
14688 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
14689 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
14690 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
14691 with -1 being the last one. A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
14692
14693http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
14694 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
14695 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
14696 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
14697 basic auth is supported.
14698
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010014699http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
14700 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
14701 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
14702 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
14703 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014704 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
14705 basic auth is supported.
14706
14707 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010014708 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
14709 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
14710 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
14711 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014712
14713http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020014714 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
14715 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014716 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
14717 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020014718
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014719method : integer + string
14720 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
14721 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
14722 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
14723 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
14724 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
14725 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
14726 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014727
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014728 ACL derivatives :
14729 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014730
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014731 Example :
14732 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
14733 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
14734 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014735
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014736path : string
14737 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
14738 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
14739 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
14740 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
14741 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
14742 used to match exact file names (eg: "/login.php"), or directory parts using
14743 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014744
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014745 ACL derivatives :
14746 path : exact string match
14747 path_beg : prefix match
14748 path_dir : subdir match
14749 path_dom : domain match
14750 path_end : suffix match
14751 path_len : length match
14752 path_reg : regex match
14753 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014754
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010014755query : string
14756 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
14757 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
14758 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
14759 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014760 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010014761 which stops before the question mark.
14762
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010014763req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
14764 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
14765 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
14766 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
14767 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
14768
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014769req.ver : string
14770req_ver : string (deprecated)
14771 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
14772 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
14773 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014774
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014775 ACL derivatives :
14776 req_ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014777
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014778res.comp : boolean
14779 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
14780 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
14781 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014782
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014783res.comp_algo : string
14784 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
14785 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
14786 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014787
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014788res.cook([<name>]) : string
14789scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14790 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14791 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
14792 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020014793
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014794 ACL derivatives :
14795 scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020014796
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014797res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14798scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14799 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
14800 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
14801 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014802
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014803res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
14804scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14805 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14806 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
14807 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010014808
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014809res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14810 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
14811 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
14812 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
14813 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
14814 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. It
14815 differs from res.hdr() in that any commas present in the value are returned
14816 and are not used as delimiters. If this is not desired, the res.hdr() fetch
14817 should be used instead. This is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or
14818 Expires.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014819
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014820res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14821 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
14822 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14823 not specified. Contrary to its res.hdr_cnt() cousin, this function returns
14824 the number of full line headers and does not stop on commas. If this is not
14825 desired, the res.hdr_cnt() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014826
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014827res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
14828shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
14829 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, or of
14830 the last header if no <name> is specified. Optionally, a specific occurrence
14831 might be specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position
14832 from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values
14833 indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This
14834 can be useful to learn some data into a stick-table. The function considers
14835 any comma as a delimiter for distinct values. If this is not desired, the
14836 res.fhdr() fetch should be used instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014837
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014838 ACL derivatives :
14839 shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
14840 shdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
14841 shdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
14842 shdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
14843 shdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
14844 shdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
14845 shdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
14846 shdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
14847
14848res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
14849shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
14850 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of response
14851 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
14852 not specified. The function considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct
14853 values. If this is not desired, the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch should be used
14854 instead.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014855
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014856res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
14857shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
14858 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response,
14859 convert it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. Optionally, a
14860 specific occurrence might be specified as a position number. Positive values
14861 indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being the first one.
14862 Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one, with -1 being
14863 the last one. This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014864
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010014865res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
14866 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
14867 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
14868 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
14869 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
14870
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014871res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
14872shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
14873 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP response, and
14874 converts it to an integer value. Optionally, a specific occurrence might be
14875 specified as a position number. Positive values indicate a position from the
14876 first occurrence, with 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
14877 positions relative to the last one, with -1 being the last one. This can be
14878 useful to learn some data into a stick table.
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010014879
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014880res.ver : string
14881resp_ver : string (deprecated)
14882 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
14883 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020014884
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014885 ACL derivatives :
14886 resp_ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010014887
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014888set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
14889 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
14890 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020014891 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014892 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010014893
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014894 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
14895 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010014896
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014897status : integer
14898 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
14899 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
14900 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014901
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020014902unique-id : string
14903 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
14904 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
14905 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
14906 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
14907 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
14908 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
14909
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014910url : string
14911 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
14912 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
14913 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
14914 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
14915 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
14916 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
14917 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014918
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014919 ACL derivatives :
14920 url : exact string match
14921 url_beg : prefix match
14922 url_dir : subdir match
14923 url_dom : domain match
14924 url_end : suffix match
14925 url_len : length match
14926 url_reg : regex match
14927 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014928
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014929url_ip : ip
14930 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
14931 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
14932 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
14933 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
14934 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
14935 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
14936 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014937
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014938url_port : integer
14939 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
14940 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
14941 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
14942 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014943
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014944urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
14945url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014946 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
14947 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014948 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
14949 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
14950 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
14951 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014952 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
14953 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020014954 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
14955 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014956
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014957 ACL derivatives :
14958 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
14959 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
14960 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
14961 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
14962 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
14963 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
14964 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
14965 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014966
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014967
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014968 Example :
14969 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
14970 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
14971 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
14972 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020014973
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030014974urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020014975 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
14976 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
14977 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020014978
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020014979url32 : integer
14980 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
14981 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
14982 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
14983 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
14984 is an unsigned integer.
14985
14986url32+src : binary
14987 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
14988 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
14989 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
14990
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +010014991
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200149927.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014993---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014994
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014995Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
14996every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020014997order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010014998
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014999ACL name Equivalent to Usage
15000---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015001FALSE always_false never match
Willy Tarreau2492d5b2009-07-11 00:06:00 +020015002HTTP req_proto_http match if protocol is valid HTTP
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015003HTTP_1.0 req_ver 1.0 match HTTP version 1.0
15004HTTP_1.1 req_ver 1.1 match HTTP version 1.1
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015005HTTP_CONTENT hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length
15006HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
15007HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
15008HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
15009LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015010METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020015011METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015012METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
15013METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
15014METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
15015METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
Daniel Schneller9ff96c72016-04-11 17:45:29 +020015016METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015017METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020015018RDP_COOKIE req_rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015019REQ_CONTENT req_len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010015020TRUE always_true always match
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015021WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
15022---------------+-----------------------------+---------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010015023
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010015024
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150258. Logging
15026----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010015027
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015028One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
15029provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
15030very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
15031provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
15032state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010015033to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015034headers.
15035
15036In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
15037about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
15038send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
15039
15040 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
15041 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
15042 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
15043 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
15044 at the termination.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060015045 - per-request control of log-level, eg:
15046 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015047
15048The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
15049allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
15050as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
15051while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
15052real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
15053delay.
15054
15055
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150568.1. Log levels
15057---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015058
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090015059TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015060source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090015061HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
15062in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
15063track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
15064syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
15065about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015066
15067
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200150688.2. Log formats
15069----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015070
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015071HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090015072and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
15073slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
15074options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015075
15076 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
15077 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
15078 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
15079 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
15080 extents.
15081
15082 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
15083 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
15084 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
15085 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
15086 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
15087
15088 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
15089 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
15090 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
15091 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
15092 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
15093
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020015094 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
15095 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
15096 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
15097 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
15098
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015099 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
15100
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015101Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
15102specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
15103field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
15104servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
15105always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
15106identifier.
15107
15108Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
15109 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
15110 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
15111 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
15112 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
15113
15114
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200151158.2.1. Default log format
15116-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015117
15118This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
15119as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
15120format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
15121
15122 Example :
15123 listen www
15124 mode http
15125 log global
15126 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15127
15128 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
15129 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
15130 (www/HTTP)
15131
15132 Field Format Extract from the example above
15133 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
15134 2 'Connect from' Connect from
15135 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
15136 4 'to' to
15137 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
15138 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
15139
15140Detailed fields description :
15141 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
15142 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
15143 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
15144 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
15145 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15146 and processed the connection.
15147 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
15148
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015149In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
15150"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
15151connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
15152
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015153It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
15154will eventually disappear.
15155
15156
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200151578.2.2. TCP log format
15158---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015159
15160The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
15161is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
15162information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
15163counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
15164emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
15165environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
15166the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
15167sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015168specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
15169not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
15170fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
15171marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015172
15173 Example :
15174 frontend fnt
15175 mode tcp
15176 option tcplog
15177 log global
15178 default_backend bck
15179
15180 backend bck
15181 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15182
15183 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
15184 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
15185 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
15186
15187 Field Format Extract from the example above
15188 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
15189 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
15190 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
15191 4 frontend_name fnt
15192 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
15193 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
15194 7 bytes_read* 212
15195 8 termination_state --
15196 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
15197 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
15198
15199Detailed fields description :
15200 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015201 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
15202 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
15203 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015204 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
15205 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
15206 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015207
15208 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015209 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
15210 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
15211 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015212
15213 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by haproxy
15214 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
15215 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
15216 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log.
15217
15218 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15219 and processed the connection.
15220
15221 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
15222 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
15223 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
15224 applications.
15225
15226 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
15227 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
15228 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
15229 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
15230 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
15231
15232 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
15233 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
15234 See "Timers" below for more details.
15235
15236 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
15237 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
15238 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
15239 "Timers" below for more details.
15240
15241 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015242 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015243 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
15244 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
15245 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
15246 details.
15247
15248 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
15249 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
15250 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
15251 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
15252 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
15253
15254 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
15255 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
15256 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
15257 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
15258 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
15259 for more details.
15260
15261 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015262 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015263 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
15264 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
15265 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015266 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015267
15268 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
15269 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
15270 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
15271 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
15272 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
15273 caused by a denial of service attack.
15274
15275 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
15276 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
15277 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
15278 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
15279 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
15280 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
15281 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
15282 denial of service attack.
15283
15284 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
15285 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
15286 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
15287 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
15288 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
15289 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
15290 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
15291 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
15292 be processed than on other servers.
15293
15294 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
15295 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
15296 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
15297 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
15298 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
15299 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
15300 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
15301 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
15302 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
15303 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
15304 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
15305 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
15306 should not be attributed to the logged server.
15307
15308 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15309 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
15310 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
15311 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
15312 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
15313 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
15314 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
15315 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
15316
15317 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15318 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
15319 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
15320 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
15321 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
15322 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
15323 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
15324 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
15325 occurs.
15326
15327
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200153288.2.3. HTTP log format
15329----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015330
15331The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
15332is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
15333the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
15334are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
15335emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
15336generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
15337"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
15338which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015339frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
15340is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015341
15342Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
15343slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
15344with a star ('*') after the field name below.
15345
15346 Example :
15347 frontend http-in
15348 mode http
15349 option httplog
15350 log global
15351 default_backend bck
15352
15353 backend static
15354 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
15355
15356 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
15357 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
15358 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015359 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015360
15361 Field Format Extract from the example above
15362 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
15363 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015364 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015365 4 frontend_name http-in
15366 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015367 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015368 7 status_code 200
15369 8 bytes_read* 2750
15370 9 captured_request_cookie -
15371 10 captured_response_cookie -
15372 11 termination_state ----
15373 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
15374 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
15375 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
15376 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
15377 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010015378
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015379Detailed fields description :
15380 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015381 connection to haproxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
15382 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
15383 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010015384 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
15385 and the NetScaler Client IP insetion protocol is correctly used, then the
15386 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015387
15388 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010015389 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
15390 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
15391 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015392
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015393 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
15394 was received by haproxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015395
15396 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
15397 and processed the connection.
15398
15399 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
15400 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
15401 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
15402
15403 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
15404 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
15405 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
15406 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
15407 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
15408 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
15409
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015410 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
15411 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
15412 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
15413 request could be received or the a bad request was received. It should
15414 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
15415 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
15416 haproxy or requests being typed by hand. See "Timers" below for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015417
15418 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
15419 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
15420 See "Timers" below for more details.
15421
15422 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
15423 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
15424 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See "Timers"
15425 below for more details.
15426
15427 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
15428 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
15429 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
15430 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
15431 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
15432 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See "Timers" below
15433 for more details.
15434
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015435 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in haproxy, which is the total
15436 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
15437 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
15438 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
15439 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
15440 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
15441 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
15442 See "Timers" below for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015443
15444 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
15445 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by haproxy when
15446 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by haproxy.
15447
15448 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
15449 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
15450 specified, the this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
15451 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
15452 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
15453 overflowing.
15454
15455 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
15456 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
15457 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
15458 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
15459 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
15460 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
15461 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
15462 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
15463
15464 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
15465 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
15466 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
15467 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
15468 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
15469 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
15470 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
15471 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
15472
15473 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
15474 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
15475 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
15476 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
15477 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
15478 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
15479 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
15480
15481 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015482 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015483 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
15484 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
15485 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015486 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015487 system.
15488
15489 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
15490 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
15491 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
15492 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
15493 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
15494 caused by a denial of service attack.
15495
15496 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
15497 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
15498 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
15499 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
15500 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
15501 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
15502 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
15503 denial of service attack.
15504
15505 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
15506 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
15507 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
15508 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
15509 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
15510 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
15511 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
15512 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
15513 processed than on other servers.
15514
15515 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
15516 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
15517 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
15518 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
15519 haproxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
15520 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
15521 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
15522 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
15523 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
15524 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
15525 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
15526 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
15527 should not be attributed to the logged server.
15528
15529 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15530 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
15531 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
15532 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
15533 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
15534 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
15535 cumulated. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
15536 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
15537
15538 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
15539 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
15540 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
15541 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
15542 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
15543 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
15544 and then both positions will be cumulated. A request should not pass
15545 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
15546 occurs.
15547
15548 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
15549 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
15550 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
15551 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
15552 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
15553 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
15554 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
15555 cookies" below for more details.
15556
15557 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
15558 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
15559 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
15560 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
15561 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
15562 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
15563 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
15564 and cookies" below for more details.
15565
15566 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
15567 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
15568 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
15569 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
15570 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
15571 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
15572 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
15573 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
15574
15575
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200155768.2.4. Custom log format
15577------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015578
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015579The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015580mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015581
15582HAproxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
15583Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
15584separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
15585prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
15586
15587Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
15588variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015589("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015590
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010015591If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020015592as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010015593less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
15594the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
15595
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015596Note: spaces must be escaped. A space character is considered as a separator.
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015597In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be preceded by another '%' resulting
Willy Tarreau06d97f92013-12-02 17:45:48 +010015598in '%%'. HAProxy will automatically merge consecutive separators.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015599
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015600Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
15601'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
15602https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
15603such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
15604
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015605Flags are :
15606 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040015607 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015608 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
15609 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015610
15611 Example:
15612
15613 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
15614 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
15615
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010015616 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
15617
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015618At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
15619
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015620 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
15621 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015622
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015623the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015624
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015625 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
15626 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
15627 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015628
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015629and the default TCP format is defined this way :
15630
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015631 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
15632 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015633
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015634Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
15635
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015636 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015637 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015638 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
15639 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
15640 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015641 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
15642 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
15643 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015644 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000015645 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
15646 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string (path) | string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000015647 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000015648 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
15649 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010015650 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020015651 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015652 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015653 | | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015654 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020015655 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080015656 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015657 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
15658 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
15659 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
15660 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
15661 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015662 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015663 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
15664 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015665 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015666 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
15667 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015668 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
15669 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
15670 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015671 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015672 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
15673 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015674 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015675 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
15676 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
15677 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020015678 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020015679 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020015680 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
15681 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
15682 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
15683 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020015684 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020015685 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015686 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015687 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010015688 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015689 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015690 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
15691 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
15692 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015693 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015694 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
15695 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010015696 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015697 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
15698 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
15699 | H | %trl | locla_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015700 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015701 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010015702 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015703
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020015704 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010015705
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010015706
157078.2.5. Error log format
15708-----------------------
15709
15710When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
15711protocol header, haproxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
15712By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
15713"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
15714will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (eg: probes) are not
15715logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
15716
15717The format looks like this :
15718
15719 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
15720 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
15721 Connection error during SSL handshake
15722
15723 Field Format Extract from the example above
15724 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
15725 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
15726 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
15727 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
15728 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
15729
15730These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
15731failures.
15732
15733
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157348.3. Advanced logging options
15735-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015736
15737Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
15738just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
15739options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
15740for more information about their usage.
15741
15742
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157438.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
15744------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015745
15746It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
15747haproxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
15748commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
15749monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
15750ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
15751
15752 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
15753 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
15754 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
15755 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
15756
15757 - if the connection come from a known source network, use "monitor-net" to
15758 declare this network as monitoring only. Any host in this network will then
15759 only be able to perform health checks, and their requests will not be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015760 logged. This is generally appropriate to designate a list of equipment
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015761 such as other load-balancers.
15762
15763 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
15764 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
15765 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
15766
15767
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157688.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
15769----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015770
15771The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
15772what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
15773or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
15774"option logasap" in the frontend. Haproxy will then log as soon as possible,
15775just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
15776log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
15777after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
15778is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
15779with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
15780with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
15781
15782
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157838.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
15784------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015785
15786Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
15787for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
15788"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
15789retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
15790raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
15791a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
15792file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
15793you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
15794"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
15795
15796
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200157978.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
15798--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020015799
15800Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
15801multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
15802them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
15803"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
15804logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
15805error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
15806and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
15807too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
15808useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
15809alternative.
15810
15811
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200158128.4. Timing events
15813------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015814
15815Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
15816reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
15817the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
15818frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015819mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
15820addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
15821
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010015822Timings events in HTTP mode:
15823
15824 first request 2nd request
15825 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
15826 t tr t tr ...
15827 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
15828 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
15829 :<---- Tq ---->: :
15830 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
15831 :<--------- Ta --------->:
15832
15833Timings events in TCP mode:
15834
15835 TCP session
15836 |<----------------->|
15837 t t
15838 ---|----|----|----|----|---
15839 | Th Tw Tc Td |
15840 |<------ Tt ------->|
15841
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015842 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
15843 protocols. Currently, these protocoles are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
15844 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
15845 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
15846 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
15847 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (eg: MTU issues), or that an
15848 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015849
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015850 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
15851 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
15852 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
15853 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. Some
15854 browsers pre-establish connections to a server in order to reduce the
15855 latency of a future request, and keep them pending until they need it. This
15856 delay will be reported as the idle time. A value of -1 indicates that
15857 nothing was received on the connection.
15858
15859 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
15860 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
15861 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
15862 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
15863 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
15864 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
15865 request typed by hand during a test.
15866
15867 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
15868 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
15869 exactly equalt to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
15870 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
15871 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
15872 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
15873 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015874
15875 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
15876 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
15877 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
15878 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
15879 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
15880
15881 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
15882 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
15883 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
15884 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
15885 connection never established.
15886
15887 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
15888 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
15889 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
15890 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
15891 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
15892 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
15893 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
15894 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
15895 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
15896 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
15897 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
15898
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015899 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
15900 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
15901 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
15902 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
15903 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
15904 by subtracting other timers when valid :
15905
15906 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
15907
15908 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
15909 "Ta" can never be negative.
15910
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015911 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
15912 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015913 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
15914 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015915 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015916
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015917 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015918
15919 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015920 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
15921 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015922
15923These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
15924protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
15925that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015926due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
15927"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
15928that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015929
15930Most common cases :
15931
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015932 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
15933 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
15934 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
15935 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
15936 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
15937 ended, haproxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
15938 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
15939 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
15940 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
15941 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
15942 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020015943 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015944
15945 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
15946 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
15947 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
15948 of ms on remote networks.
15949
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020015950 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
15951 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
15952 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015953
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015954 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
15955 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
15956 haproxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
15957 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
15958 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
15959 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
15960 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
15961 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
15962 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015963
15964Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
15965
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015966 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015967 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015968 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015969
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015970 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015971 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
15972 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
15973
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015974 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015975 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
15976 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
15977 flags.
15978
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015979 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
15980 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015981 Check the session termination flags, then check the
15982 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
15983 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
15984 the client connection was maintained open.
15985
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015986 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015987 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020015988 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015989 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
15990
15991
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200159928.5. Session state at disconnection
15993-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010015994
15995TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
15996"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
159972-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
15998each of which has a special meaning :
15999
16000 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
16001 session to terminate :
16002
16003 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
16004
16005 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
16006 server explicitly refused it.
16007
16008 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
16009 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
16010 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
16011 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020016012 (eg: cacheable cookie).
16013
16014 L : the session was locally processed by haproxy and was not passed to
16015 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016016
16017 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
16018 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
16019 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
16020 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
16021 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
16022
16023 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
16024 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
16025 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
16026 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
16027 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
16028
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090016029 D : the session was killed by haproxy because the server was detected
16030 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
16031
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070016032 U : the session was killed by haproxy on this backup server because an
16033 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
16034 backup connections when going up.
16035
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020016036 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on haproxy.
16037
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016038 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
16039 send or receive data.
16040
16041 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
16042 send or receive data.
16043
16044 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
16045 with nothing left in the buffers.
16046
16047 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
16048
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010016049 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016050 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
16051
16052 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
16053 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
16054 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
16055 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
16056 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
16057
16058 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
16059 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
16060
16061 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
16062 server (HTTP only).
16063
16064 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
16065
16066 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
16067 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
16068 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
16069
16070 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
16071 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
16072 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
16073
16074 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
16075
16076 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
16077 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
16078
16079 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
16080 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
16081 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
16082
16083 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
16084 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020016085 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
16086 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016087
16088 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
16089 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
16090 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
16091 another server.
16092
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016093 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016094 server.
16095
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016096 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
16097 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
16098 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
16099 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
16100
16101 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
16102 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
16103 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
16104 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
16105
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020016106 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
16107 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
16108 "use-server" rule).
16109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016110 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
16111
16112 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
16113 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
16114
16115 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
16116
16117 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
16118 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
16119 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
16120
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016121 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
16122 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030016123 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016124 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
16125 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
16126
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016127 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
16128
16129 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
16130 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
16131
16132 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
16133
16134 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
16135
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016136The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
16137was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016138helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
16139starvation, attacks, etc...
16140
16141The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
16142alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
16143easier finding and understanding.
16144
16145 Flags Reason
16146
16147 -- Normal termination.
16148
16149 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
16150 server. This can happen when haproxy tries to connect to a recently
16151 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while haproxy is
16152 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
16153
16154 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
16155 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
16156 client and haproxy which decided to actively break the connection,
16157 by network routing issues between the client and haproxy, or by a
16158 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
16159 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016160
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016161 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
16162 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020016163 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016164
16165 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
16166 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
16167 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
16168
16169 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
16170 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
16171 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
16172 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
16173 the server takes too long to respond.
16174
16175 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
16176 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
16177 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
16178 long a time to respond.
16179
16180 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
16181 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
16182 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
16183 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between haproxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020016184 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
16185 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016186
16187 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
16188 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
16189 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
16190 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
16191 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020016192 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020016193 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
16194 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
16195 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
16196 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
16197 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
16198 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
16199 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
16200 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
16201 around the undesirable effects of this behaviour by adding "option
16202 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
16203 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
16204 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016205
16206 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
16207 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020016208 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
16209 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
16210 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
16211 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016212
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020016213 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by haproxy. Generally
16214 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
16215
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016216 SC The server or an equipment between it and haproxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016217 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
16218 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
16219 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (eg: no route,
16220 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
16221 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
16222
16223 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
16224 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
16225 503 or 504 here.
16226
16227 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
16228 transfer. This usually means that haproxy has received an RST from
16229 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
16230 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
16231 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
16232
16233 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
16234 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016235 by too short timeouts on L4 equipments before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016236 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
16237 between the client and the server expiring first on haproxy.
16238
16239 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
16240 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
16241 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
16242 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
16243 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
16244 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
16245 between haproxy and the server.
16246
16247 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
16248 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
16249 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
16250 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
16251 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
16252 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
16253 solution is to fix the application.
16254
16255 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
16256 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
16257 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
16258 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
16259 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
16260 external attacks.
16261
16262 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
16263 process' socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020016264 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016265 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
16266 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
16267
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016268 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
16269 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
16270 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020016271 the client. Haproxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
16272 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016273
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016274 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
16275 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
16276 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
16277 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010016278 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
16279 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
16280 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
16281 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
16282 logs.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016283
16284 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
16285 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
16286 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
16287 returned an HTTP 403 error.
16288
16289 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
16290 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
16291 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
16292 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
16293
16294 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
16295 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
16296 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
16297 only be solved by proper system tuning.
16298
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016299The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
16300persistence was handled by the client, the server and by haproxy. This is very
16301important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
16302re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
16303
16304 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
16305
16306 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
16307 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
16308 set on a GET request.
16309
16310 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
16311 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016312 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020016313 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
16314
16315 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
16316 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
16317 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
16318
16319 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
16320 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
16321 already got a cookie.
16322
16323 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
16324 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
16325 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
16326 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
16327 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
16328
16329 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
16330 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
16331 new cookie was inserted in the response.
16332
16333 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
16334 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
16335 new cookie was inserted in the response.
16336
16337 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
16338 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
16339
16340 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
16341 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
16342 then advertised in the response.
16343
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016344
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163458.6. Non-printable characters
16346-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016347
16348In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
16349consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
16350converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
16351prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
16352being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
16353escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
16354is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
16355'}' when logging headers.
16356
16357Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
16358issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
16359containing spaces is "User-Agent".
16360
16361Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
16362the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
16363performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
16364
16365
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163668.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
16367---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016368
16369Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
16370achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016371section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016372cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
16373the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
16374the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016375locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016376not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
16377user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
16378a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
16379wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
16380
16381 Examples :
16382 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
16383 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
16384
16385 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
16386 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
16387
16388
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200163898.8. Capturing HTTP headers
16390---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016391
16392Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
16393proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
16394the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
16395server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
16396
16397Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
16398response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016399section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016400
16401It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016402time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
16403appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016404are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
16405and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
16406follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
16407request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
16408in the logs.
16409
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020016410As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
16411frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
16412an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
16413
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016414 Example :
16415 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
16416 listen proxy-out
16417 mode http
16418 option httplog
16419 option logasap
16420 log global
16421 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
16422
16423 # log the name of the virtual server
16424 capture request header Host len 20
16425
16426 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
16427 capture request header Content-Length len 10
16428
16429 # log the beginning of the referrer
16430 capture request header Referer len 20
16431
16432 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
16433 capture response header Server len 20
16434
16435 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
16436 capture response header Content-Length len 10
16437
16438 # log the expected cache behaviour on the response
16439 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
16440
16441 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
16442 capture response header Via len 20
16443
16444 # log the URL location during a redirection
16445 capture response header Location len 20
16446
16447 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
16448 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
16449 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16450 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
16451 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
16452
16453 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
16454 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
16455 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16456 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016457 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016458
16459 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
16460 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
16461 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
16462 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
16463 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016464 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016465
16466
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200164678.9. Examples of logs
16468---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016469
16470These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
16471them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
16472reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
16473
16474 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
16475 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
16476 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
16477
16478 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
16479 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
16480
16481 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
16482 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
16483 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
16484
16485 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
16486 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
16487
16488 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
16489 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
16490 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
16491
16492 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010016493 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016494 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
16495 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
16496
16497 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
16498 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
16499 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
16500
16501 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "rspdeny" or
16502 "rspideny" filter, or because the response was improperly formatted and
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020016503 not HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016504 risked being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502
16505 bad gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was haproxy who decided
16506 to return the 502 and not the server.
16507
16508 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016509 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016510
16511 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
16512 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
16513 Nothing was sent to any server.
16514
16515 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
16516 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
16517
16518 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
16519 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
16520 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
16521 send a 408 return code to the client.
16522
16523 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
16524 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
16525
16526 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
16527 5 seconds ("c----").
16528
16529 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
16530 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010016531 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016532
16533 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020016534 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010016535 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
16536 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
16537 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
16538 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
16539 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010016540
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020016541
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200165429. Supported filters
16543--------------------
16544
16545Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
16546accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
16547unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
16548
16549See also : "filter"
16550
165519.1. Trace
16552----------
16553
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010016554filter trace [name <name>] [random-parsing] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020016555
16556 Arguments:
16557 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
16558 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
16559
16560 <random-parsing> enables the random parsing of data exchanged between
16561 the client and the server. By default, this filter
16562 parses all available data. With this parameter, it
16563 only parses a random amount of the available data.
16564
16565 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwading of parsed data. By
16566 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
16567 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
16568 amount of the parsed data.
16569
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010016570 <hexump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
16571
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020016572This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
16573callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
16574information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
16575filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
16576
16577Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
16578tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
16579a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
16580
16581
165829.2. HTTP compression
16583---------------------
16584
16585filter compression
16586
16587The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
16588keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
16589when no other filter is used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly
16590use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when two or more filters are
16591used for the same listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the
16592filters evaluation order.
16593
16594See also : "compression"
16595
16596
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200165979.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
16598--------------------------------------------
16599
16600filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
16601
16602 Arguments :
16603
16604 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
16605 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
16606 parsed.
16607
16608 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
16609 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
16610 part must be placed in its own scope.
16611
16612The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
16613external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
16614streams in tierce applications. These external components and information
16615exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
16616also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
16617
16618SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
16619the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
16620
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016621For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020016622"doc/SPOE.txt".
16623
16624Important note:
16625 The SPOE filter is highly experimental for now and was not heavily
16626 tested. It is really not production ready. So use it carefully.
16627
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016628/*
16629 * Local variables:
16630 * fill-column: 79
16631 * End:
16632 */